blob: 81b641eae1a923226f2469b5da45f75f9305f594 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - tune.buffers.limit
594 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200596 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100597 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100598 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200599 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100600 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100602 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100603 - tune.lua.session-timeout
604 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200605 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100606 - tune.maxaccept
607 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200608 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200609 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200610 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100611 - tune.rcvbuf.client
612 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100613 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.sndbuf.client
615 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100616 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200618 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100619 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200620 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200621 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100622 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200623 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100624 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200625 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
626 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
627 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100628 - tune.zlib.memlevel
629 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631 * Debugging
632 - debug
633 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634
635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006363.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637------------------------------------
638
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639ca-base <dir>
640 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200641 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
642 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644chroot <jail dir>
645 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
646 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
647 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
648 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
649 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
650 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100651
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100652cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
653 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
654 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
655 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100656 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
657 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
658 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
659 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
660 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
661 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
662 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
663 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
664 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
665 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100666
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200667crt-base <dir>
668 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
669 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
670 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672daemon
673 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
674 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
675 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
676
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200677deviceatlas-json-file <path>
678 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
679 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
680
681deviceatlas-log-level <value>
682 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
683 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
684
685deviceatlas-separator <char>
686 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
687 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
688
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100689deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200690 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
691 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
692 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900694external-check
695 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
696 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
697 See "option external-check".
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699gid <number>
700 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
701 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
702 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100703 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
704 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100707hard-stop-after <time>
708 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
709
710 Arguments :
711 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
712 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
713 SIGUSR1 signal.
714
715 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
716 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
717 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
718
719 Example:
720 global
721 hard-stop-after 30s
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723group <group name>
724 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
725 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100726
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
729 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100730 configured with "log global".
731
732 <address> can be one of:
733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100734 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
736 port).
737
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100738 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
739 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
740 port).
741
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100742 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
743 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
744 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
745 writeable).
746
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200747 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
748 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100749
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200750 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
751 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
752 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
753 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
754 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
755 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
756 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
757 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
758 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
759 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
760 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
761
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200762 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
763 one of the following :
764
765 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
766 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
767
768 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
769 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
770
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100771 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
773 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
774 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
775 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
776
777 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200778 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
779 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
780 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
781 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
782 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
783 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200785 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100787log-send-hostname [<string>]
788 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
789 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
790 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
791 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
792 the logs.
793
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000794log-tag <string>
795 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
796 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
797 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100798 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100800lua-load <file>
801 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
802 used multiple times.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804nbproc <number>
805 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
806 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
807 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
808 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
809 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
810
811pidfile <pidfile>
812 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
813 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
814 starting the process. See also "daemon".
815
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100816presetenv <name> <value>
817 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
818 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
819 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
820 and "unsetenv".
821
822resetenv [<name> ...]
823 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
824 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
825 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
826 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
827 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
828 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
829 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
830 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
831
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100832stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200833 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
834 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
835 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
836 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
837 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
838 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100839 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200840 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
841 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200842
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200843server-state-base <directory>
844 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200845 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
846 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200847
848server-state-file <file>
849 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
850 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
851 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
852 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
853 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
854 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
855 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
856 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200857 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
858 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200859
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100860setenv <name> <value>
861 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
862 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
863 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
864 and "unsetenv".
865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100866ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300869 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100870 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
871 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
872 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
873 "bind" keyword for more information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
880 Example:
881 global
882 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
886 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
889 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
890 information.
891
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100892ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
894 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
895 keyword to see available options.
896
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200897ssl-dh-param-file <file>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
900 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
901 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
902 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200903 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
904 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
905 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
906 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200907 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
908 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
909 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
910
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100911ssl-server-verify [none|required]
912 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
913 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
914 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
915
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200916stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
917 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
918 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
919 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200920 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
921 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200922
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200923 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
924 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
925 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200926
927stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
928 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
929 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100930 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200931
932stats maxconn <connections>
933 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
934 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936uid <number>
937 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
938 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
939 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
940 one. See also "gid" and "user".
941
942ulimit-n <number>
943 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
944 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
945 option.
946
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100947unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
948 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
949
950 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
951 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
952 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
953 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
954 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
955 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
956 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
957 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
958 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
959 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
960
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100961unsetenv [<name> ...]
962 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
963 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
964 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
965 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
966 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
967 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
968 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970user <user name>
971 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
972 See also "uid" and "group".
973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200974node <name>
975 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
976
977 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
978 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
979 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
980 traffic.
981
982description <text>
983 Add a text that describes the instance.
984
985 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
986 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
987 "<" and ">" characters.
988
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010098951degrees-data-file <file path>
990 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
991 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
992
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200993 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100994 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
995
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
998 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
999 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1000
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001001 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001002 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1003
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001005 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1006 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1007
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1009 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1010
101151degrees-cache-size <number>
1012 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1013 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1014 By default, this cache is disabled.
1015
1016 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1018
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001019wurfl-data-file <file path>
1020 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1021 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1022
1023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1024 with USE_WURFL=1.
1025
1026wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1027 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1028 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1029 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1030
1031 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1032
1033 Valid WURFL properties are:
1034 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1035
1036 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1037 device.
1038
1039 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1040 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1041
1042 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1043 particular web request.
1044
1045 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1046 used Libwurfl API version.
1047
1048 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1049 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1050 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1051
1052 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1053 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1054
1055 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1056 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1057
1058 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1061
1062 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1063 with USE_WURFL=1.
1064
1065wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1066 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1067 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1068
1069 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1070 with USE_WURFL=1.
1071
1072wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1073 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1074 thus before the chroot.
1075
1076 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1077 with USE_WURFL=1.
1078
1079wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1080 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1081 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1082 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1083 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1084 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1085 mode is enabled by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1091 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1092 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1093 - "0" : no cache is used.
1094 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1095 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1096 the highest performing option.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1102 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1103 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110-----------------------
1111
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001112max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1113 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1114 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1115 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1116 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1117 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1118 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1119 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1120 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122maxconn <number>
1123 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1124 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1125 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001126 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1127 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1128 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1129 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001130 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1131 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1132 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1133 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1134 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001136maxconnrate <number>
1137 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1138 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1139 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1140 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1141 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1142 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1143 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1144 fairness.
1145
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001146maxcomprate <number>
1147 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001148 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001149 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1150 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1151 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1152 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1153 default value.
1154
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001155maxcompcpuusage <number>
1156 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1157 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1158 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1159 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1160 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1161 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1162 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1163 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1164
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001165maxpipes <number>
1166 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1167 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1168 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1169 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1170 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1171 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1172
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001173maxsessrate <number>
1174 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1175 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1176 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1177 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1178 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1179 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1180 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1181 fairness.
1182
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001183maxsslconn <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1185 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1186 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1187 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1188 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1189 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1190 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001191 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1192 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1193 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1194 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1195 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1196 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1197 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001198
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001199maxsslrate <number>
1200 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1201 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1202 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1203 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1204 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1205 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1206 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1207 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1208 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1209 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1210
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001211maxzlibmem <number>
1212 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1213 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1214 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001215 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1216 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1217 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219noepoll
1220 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1221 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001222 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001223
1224nokqueue
1225 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1226 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1227 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1228
1229nopoll
1230 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1231 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001233 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001235nosplice
1236 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1237 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1238 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001239 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001240 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1241 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1242 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1243 "option splice-response".
1244
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001245nogetaddrinfo
1246 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1247 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1248
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001249noreuseport
1250 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1251 command line argument "-dR".
1252
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001253spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001254 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1255 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1256 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1257 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1258 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1259 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001261tune.buffers.limit <number>
1262 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1263 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1264 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1265 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1266 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1267 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1268 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1269 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1270 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1271 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1272 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1273 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1274 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1275 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1276 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1277
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001278tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1279 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1280 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1281 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1282 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1283
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001284tune.bufsize <number>
1285 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1286 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1287 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1288 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1289 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1290 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1291 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1292 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001293 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1294 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1295 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001296
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001297tune.chksize <number>
1298 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1299 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1300 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1301 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1302 checks whenever possible.
1303
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001304tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1305 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1306 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1307 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1308 this value. The default value is 1.
1309
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001310tune.http.cookielen <number>
1311 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1312 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1313 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1314 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1315 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1316 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1317 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1318 to change this value.
1319
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001320tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1321 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1322 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1323 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1324 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1325 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1326 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1327 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1328 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1329 limit too high.
1330
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001331tune.idletimer <timeout>
1332 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1333 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1334 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1335 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1336 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1337 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1338 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1339 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1340 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1341
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1343 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001344 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1346 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1347 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1348 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1349 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1350
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001351tune.lua.maxmem
1352 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1353 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1354 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1355 memory.
1356
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001357tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1358 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001359 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1360 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1361 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001362
1363tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1364 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1365 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1366 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1367 check servers.
1368
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001369tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1370 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1371 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1372 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1373 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1374
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001375tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001376 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1377 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1378 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1379 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1380 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1381 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1382 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1383 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1384 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1385 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001386
1387tune.maxpollevents <number>
1388 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1389 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1390 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1391 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1392 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1393
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001394tune.maxrewrite <number>
1395 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1396 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1397 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1398 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1399 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1400 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1401 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1402 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1403 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1404 bufsize.
1405
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001406tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1407 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1408 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1409 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1410 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1411 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1412 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1413 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1414 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1415 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1416 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1417 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1418 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1419 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1420 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1421 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1422 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1423 setting this parameter to 0.
1424
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001425tune.pipesize <number>
1426 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1427 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1428 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1429 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1430 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1431 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1434tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1436 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001443tune.recv_enough <number>
1444 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1445 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1446 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1447 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1448 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1449
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001450tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1451tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1452 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1453 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1454 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1455 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1456 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1457 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1458 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1459 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1460 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1461 notifying haproxy again.
1462
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001463tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001464 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1465 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1466 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001467 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001468 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1469 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1470 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1471 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1472 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001473 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1474 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001475
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001476tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1477 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1478 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1479 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1480 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1481 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1482 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1483
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001484tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1485 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001486 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001487 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1488 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1489 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1490 being used for too long.
1491
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001492tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1493 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1494 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1495 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1496 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1497 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1498 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1499 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1500 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1501 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1502 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001503 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1504 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001505
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001506tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1508 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1509 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1510 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1511 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1512 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1513 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001514 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1515 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001516
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001517tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1518 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1519 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1520 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1521 1000 entries.
1522
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001523tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1524 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1525 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1526 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001528tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001529tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001530tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1531tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1532tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001533 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1534 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1535 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1536 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1537 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1538 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1539 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1540 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001541
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001542 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1543 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1544 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1545 all available space is consumed.
1546 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1547 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1548 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001549
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001550tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1551 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001552 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001553 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1554 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1555 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1556
1557tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1558 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1559 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1560 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1561 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015633.3. Debugging
1564--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001565
1566debug
1567 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1568 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1569 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1570 system startup.
1571
1572quiet
1573 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1574 line argument "-q".
1575
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015773.4. Userlists
1578--------------
1579It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1580http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1581it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1582
1583userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001584 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001585 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1586
1587group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001588 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1590 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1591
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001592user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1593 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001594 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1595 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001596 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1597 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001598 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001599 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001600
1601
1602 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001603 userlist L1
1604 group G1 users tiger,scott
1605 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001606
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001607 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1608 user scott insecure-password elgato
1609 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001610
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001611 userlist L2
1612 group G1
1613 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001614
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001615 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1616 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1617 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001618
1619 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001621
16223.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001624It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1625several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1626instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1627values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1628automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1629In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1630using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1631tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1632reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1633Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1634that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1635each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001636
1637peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001638 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001639 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1640
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001641disabled
1642 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1643 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1644 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1645
1646enable
1647 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1648
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001649peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1650 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1651 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1652 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1653 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1654 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1655 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1656
1657 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1658 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1659
1660 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1661 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1662 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1663 across all peers.
1664
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001665 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1666 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001668 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001669 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001670 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1671 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1672 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001673
1674 backend mybackend
1675 mode tcp
1676 balance roundrobin
1677 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1678 stick on src
1679
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001680 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1681 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001682
1683
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016843.6. Mailers
1685------------
1686It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1687If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1688in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1689
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001690mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001691 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1692 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1693
1694mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1695 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 mailers mymailers
1699 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1700 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1701
1702 backend mybackend
1703 mode tcp
1704 balance roundrobin
1705
1706 email-alert mailers mymailers
1707 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1708 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1709
1710 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1711 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1712
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001713timeout mail <time>
1714 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1715 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1716 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1717 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 mailers mymailers
1721 timeout mail 20s
1722 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001728 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729 - frontend <name>
1730 - backend <name>
1731 - listen <name>
1732
1733A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1734its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1735section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
1738A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1739connections.
1740
1741A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1742to forward incoming connections.
1743
1744A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1745parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1748'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1749case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1750
1751Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1752logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1753proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1754However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1755name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1756
1757Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1758and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001759bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1761modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1762arbitrary criteria.
1763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001764In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1765a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1766the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1767
1768 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1769 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1770 between responses and new requests.
1771
1772 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1773 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1774 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1775 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1776
1777 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1778 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1779 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1780
1781 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1782 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1783 client-facing connection remains open.
1784
1785 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1786 after the end of the response.
1787
1788The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1789frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1790following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1791weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1792
1793 Backend mode
1794
1795 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1796 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1797 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1798 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1799 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1800 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1801 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1802 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1803 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1804 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1805 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1810--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001812The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1813limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1814they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1815limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001816marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001817option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001818and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1819with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1820specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001822
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1824------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1825acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001826appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827backlog X X X -
1828balance X - X X
1829bind - X X -
1830bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001831block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832capture cookie - X X -
1833capture request header - X X -
1834capture response header - X X -
1835clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001836compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001837contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1838cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001839declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001840default-server X - X X
1841default_backend X X X -
1842description - X X X
1843disabled X X X X
1844dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001845email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001846email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001847email-alert mailers X X X X
1848email-alert myhostname X X X X
1849email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850enabled X X X X
1851errorfile X X X X
1852errorloc X X X X
1853errorloc302 X X X X
1854-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1855errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001856force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001857filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001858fullconn X - X X
1859grace X X X X
1860hash-type X - X X
1861http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001862http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001863http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001864http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001865http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001866http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001867http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001868id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001869ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001870load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001871log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001872log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001873log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001874log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001875max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876maxconn X X X -
1877mode X X X X
1878monitor fail - X X -
1879monitor-net X X X -
1880monitor-uri X X X -
1881option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1882option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1883option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1884option allbackups (*) X - X X
1885option checkcache (*) X - X X
1886option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1887option contstats (*) X X X -
1888option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1889option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1890option forceclose (*) X X X X
1891-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1892option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001893option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001894option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001895option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001896option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001897option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001898option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001899option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1901option httpchk X - X X
1902option httpclose (*) X X X X
1903option httplog X X X X
1904option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001905option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001906option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1909option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1910option logasap (*) X X X -
1911option mysql-check X - X X
1912option nolinger (*) X X X X
1913option originalto X X X X
1914option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001915option pgsql-check X - X X
1916option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001917option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001918option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919option smtpchk X - X X
1920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1922option splice-request (*) X X X X
1923option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001924option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001925option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1926option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1927-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001928option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001929option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1930option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1931option tcpka X X X X
1932option tcplog X X X X
1933option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001934external-check command X - X X
1935external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1937rate-limit sessions X X X -
1938redirect - X X X
1939redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1940redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1941reqadd - X X X
1942reqallow - X X X
1943reqdel - X X X
1944reqdeny - X X X
1945reqiallow - X X X
1946reqidel - X X X
1947reqideny - X X X
1948reqipass - X X X
1949reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001950reqitarpit - X X X
1951reqpass - X X X
1952reqrep - X X X
1953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954reqtarpit - X X X
1955retries X - X X
1956rspadd - X X X
1957rspdel - X X X
1958rspdeny - X X X
1959rspidel - X X X
1960rspideny - X X X
1961rspirep - X X X
1962rsprep - X X X
1963server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001964server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965source X - X X
1966srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001967stats admin - X X X
1968stats auth X X X X
1969stats enable X X X X
1970stats hide-version X X X X
1971stats http-request - X X X
1972stats realm X X X X
1973stats refresh X X X X
1974stats scope X X X X
1975stats show-desc X X X X
1976stats show-legends X X X X
1977stats show-node X X X X
1978stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1980stick match - - X X
1981stick on - - X X
1982stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001983stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001984stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001985tcp-check connect - - X X
1986tcp-check expect - - X X
1987tcp-check send - - X X
1988tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001989tcp-request connection - X X -
1990tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001991tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001992tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001993tcp-response content - - X X
1994tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995timeout check X - X X
1996timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001997timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1999timeout connect X - X X
2000timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2001timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2002timeout http-request X X X X
2003timeout queue X - X X
2004timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002005timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002006timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2007timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002008timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002010unique-id-format X X X -
2011unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002013use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2015 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2019---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2022
2023
2024acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2025 Declare or complete an access list.
2026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2027 no | yes | yes | yes
2028 Example:
2029 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2030 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2031 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002033 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034
2035
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002036appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2037 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 no | no | yes | yes
2041 Arguments :
2042 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2043 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2044
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002045 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 checked in each cookie value.
2047
2048 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2049 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2050 milliseconds.
2051
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002052 request-learn
2053 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2054 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2055 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2056 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2057 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2058 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2059
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002060 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2061 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2062 data following this prefix.
2063
2064 Example :
2065 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2066
2067 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2068 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2069
2070 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2071 2 modes are currently supported :
2072 - path-parameters :
2073 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2074 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2075 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2076 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2077 - query-string :
2078 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2079 query string.
2080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002081 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2082 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2083 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002085 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2086 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087
2088
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002089backlog <conns>
2090 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 yes | yes | yes | no
2093 Arguments :
2094 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2095 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002097
2098 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2099 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2100 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2101 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2102 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2103 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2104 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2105 backlog parameter.
2106
2107 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2108 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2109 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2110
2111 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2112
2113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002115balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | no | yes | yes
2119 Arguments :
2120 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2121 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2122 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2123 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2124
2125 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2126 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2127 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2128 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002129 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002130 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002131 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2132 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2133 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2134 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2135 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2136 it, so that you don't worry.
2137
2138 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2139 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2140 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2141 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2142 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2143 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2144 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2145 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002147 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2148 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2149 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2150 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2151 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2152 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2153 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2154 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2155
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002156 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002157 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002158 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2159 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002160 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002161 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2162 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2163 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2164 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2165 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002166 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2167 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2168 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2169 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2170 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2171 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2174 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2175 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2176 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2177 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2178 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2179 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2180 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002181 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002183 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2184 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2185 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002187 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2188 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2189 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2190 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2191 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2192 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2193 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2194 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2195 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2196 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2197 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2198 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002200 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002201 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2202 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2203 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2204 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2205 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2206 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2207 URIs start with a leading "/".
2208
2209 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2210 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2211 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2212 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002215 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2216
2217 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002218 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2219 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002220 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2221 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2222 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2223 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002224 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002225 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2226 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002227
2228 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2229 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2230 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2231 server will receive the request.
2232
2233 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2234 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2235 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2236 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2237 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002238 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2239 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2240 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002242 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2243 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2244 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2245 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2246 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002249 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2250 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2251 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2252
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002253 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2254 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2255 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2256
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002257 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002258 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002259 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2260 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2261 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2262 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2263 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2264 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002265 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002266 used instead.
2267
2268 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2269 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2270 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2271 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2272
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002273 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2274 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2275 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2276
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002277 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002280 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2281 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002283 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2284 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2285 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286
2287 Examples :
2288 balance roundrobin
2289 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002291 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2292 balance hdr(host)
2293 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002294
2295 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2296 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002298 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002299 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2300 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2301 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2302 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2303
2304 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2305 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2306 defaults to 16 kB.
2307
2308 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2309 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2310
2311 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2312 Round Robin.
2313
2314 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2315 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2316 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2317 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2318
2319 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2320
2321 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002322 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002323 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2324 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2325 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002327 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328
2329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002330bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2331bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2334 no | yes | yes | no
2335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002336 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2337 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2338 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2339 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002340 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002341 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2342 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2343 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2344 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2345 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2346 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2347 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002348 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2349 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2350 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2351 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2352 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2353 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2354 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002355 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2356 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2357 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2359 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2360 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002361
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002362 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2363 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002364 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2365 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2366 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002367 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2368 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2369 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2370 the range.
2371
2372 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2373 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2374 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2375 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2376 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2377 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2378 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002379 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002380 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002382 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2383 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2384 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2385 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2386 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2387 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2388 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2389 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002391 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2392 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2393 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2394 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2397 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2398 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2399 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2400 in a frontend.
2401
2402 Example :
2403 listen http_proxy
2404 bind :80,:443
2405 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002406 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002408 listen http_https_proxy
2409 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002410 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002411
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002412 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2413 bind ipv6@:80
2414 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2415 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2416
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002417 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002418 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002419
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002420 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2421 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2422 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2423 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2424 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2425
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002426 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002427 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
2429
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002431 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2436 may be used to override a default value.
2437
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002438 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002439 option may be combined with other numbers.
2440
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002441 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002442 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2443 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2444 missing from all processes.
2445
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002446 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002447 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002448 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2449 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2450 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2451 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002452
2453 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2454 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2455 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2456 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2457 and 'even' instances.
2458
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002459 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2460 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2461 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2462 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2465 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2466
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002467 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2468 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2469 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2470
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002471 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2472 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2473
2474 Example :
2475 listen app_ip1
2476 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002477 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002478
2479 listen app_ip2
2480 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002481 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002482
2483 listen management
2484 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002485 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002487 listen management
2488 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2489 bind-process 1-4
2490
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002491 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002492
2493
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002494block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 no | yes | yes | yes
2498
2499 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2500 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002502 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2504 "block" statements per instance.
2505
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002506 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2507 "http-request deny" instead.
2508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002509 Example:
2510 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2511 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2512 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002513 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2514 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2515 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002517 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002518
2519
2520capture cookie <name> len <length>
2521 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2523 no | yes | yes | no
2524 Arguments :
2525 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2526 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2527 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2528 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2529 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2530
2531 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2532 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2533 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2534 right if it exceeds <length>.
2535
2536 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2537 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2538 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2539 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2540
2541 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2542 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2543 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2544
2545 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2546 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2547 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002548 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2549 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2550 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002551
2552 Example:
2553 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2554
2555 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002556 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002557
2558
2559capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002560 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2562 no | yes | yes | no
2563 Arguments :
2564 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002565 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2567 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2568 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2569
2570 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2571 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2572 it exceeds <length>.
2573
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002574 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2576 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002577 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2578 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2579 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2580 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002581 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002582 environments to find where the request came from.
2583
2584 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2585 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2586 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2587 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002588
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002589 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2590 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2591 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2592 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2593 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002594
2595 Example:
2596 capture request header Host len 15
2597 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002598 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002600 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 about logging.
2602
2603
2604capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002605 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2607 no | yes | yes | no
2608 Arguments :
2609 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002610 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2612 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2613 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2614
2615 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2616 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2617 it exceeds <length>.
2618
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002619 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2621 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2622 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002623 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2624 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2625 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2626 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002628 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2629 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2630 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2631 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2632 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
2634 Example:
2635 capture response header Content-length len 9
2636 capture response header Location len 15
2637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002638 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639 about logging.
2640
2641
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002642clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2645 yes | yes | yes | no
2646 Arguments :
2647 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2648 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2649 as explained at the top of this document.
2650
2651 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2652 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2653 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2654 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2655 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2656 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2657 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2658 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002659 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2661 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2662
2663 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2664 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2665 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2666 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2667 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2668 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2669
2670 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2671 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2672
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002673 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2674 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002676compression algo <algorithm> ...
2677compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002678compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002679 Enable HTTP compression.
2680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2681 yes | yes | yes | yes
2682 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002683 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2684 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2685 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2686
2687 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002688 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2689 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2690 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002691
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002692 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002693 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002694
2695 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2696 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2697 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2698 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2699 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002700 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002701
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002702 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2703 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2704 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2705 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2706 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2707 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2708 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002709 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002710
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002711 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002712 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002713 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2714 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2715 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2716 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2717 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002718
2719 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2720 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2721 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2722 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2723 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002724 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2725 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2726 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2727 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2728 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002729 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2730 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002731
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002732 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002733 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2734 "Accept-Encoding" header
2735 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002736 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002737 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2738 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002739 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2740 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2741 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2742 "multipart"
2743 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2744 header
2745 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2746 and later
2747 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2748 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002749
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002750 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2751 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002752
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002753 Examples :
2754 compression algo gzip
2755 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002756
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002757
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002758contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2761 yes | no | yes | yes
2762 Arguments :
2763 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2764 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2765 as explained at the top of this document.
2766
2767 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002768 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002769 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2771 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2772 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2773 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2774
2775 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2776 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2777 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2778 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2779 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2780 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2781
2782 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2783 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2784 instead.
2785
2786 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2787 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2788
2789
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002790cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002791 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2792 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002793 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002794 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2796 yes | no | yes | yes
2797 Arguments :
2798 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2799 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2800 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2801 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2802 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2803 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2804 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2805 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2806 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2807
2808 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2809 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2810 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2811 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2812 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2813 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002814 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2815 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2816 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2817 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2818 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819
2820 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002821 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002822
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002823 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002824 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2825 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2826 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2827 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2828 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2829 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2830 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2831 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2832 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2833 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834
2835 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2836 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2837 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2838 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2839 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2840 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2841 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2842 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2843 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002844 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002845 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2846 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2847 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002848
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002849 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2850 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2851 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002852 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2853 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2854 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2855 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002856 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2857 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2858 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
2860 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2861 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2862 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2863 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2864 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2865 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2866 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2867 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2868 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2869
2870 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2871 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2872 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2873 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2874 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2875 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2876 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2877 persistence cookie in the cache.
2878 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2879
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002880 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2881 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2882 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2883 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2884 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2885 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2886 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2887 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2888 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2889 they logout.
2890
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002891 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2892 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2893 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2894 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2895
2896 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2897 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2898 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2899 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2900 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2901 this attribute.
2902
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002903 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002904 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002905 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2906 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2907 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2908 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2909 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2910 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002911
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002912 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2913 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2914 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2915 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2916 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2917 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2918 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2919 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2920 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2921 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2922 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2923 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2924 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2925 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2926 the site.
2927
2928 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2929 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2930 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2931 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2932 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2933 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2934 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2935 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2936 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2937 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2938 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2939 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2940 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2941 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2942 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2943 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2944
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002945 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2946 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2947 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2948 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2949 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2950 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002952 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2953 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2954 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2955 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957 Examples :
2958 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2959 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2960 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002961 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002963 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002965
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002966declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2967 Declares a capture slot.
2968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2969 no | yes | yes | no
2970 Arguments:
2971 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2972
2973 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2974 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2975 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2976 for use in the response.
2977
2978 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002979 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002980 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2981
2982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002983default-server [param*]
2984 Change default options for a server in a backend
2985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2986 yes | no | yes | yes
2987 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002988 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2989 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2990 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2991 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002992
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002993 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002994 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2995
2996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002999default_backend <backend>
3000 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3002 yes | yes | yes | no
3003 Arguments :
3004 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3005
3006 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3007 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3008 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3009 will catch all undetermined requests.
3010
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003011 Example :
3012
3013 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3014 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3015 default_backend dynamic
3016
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003017 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003019
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003020description <string>
3021 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3023 no | yes | yes | yes
3024 Arguments : string
3025
3026 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3027 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3028 it describes.
3029 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3030
3031
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003032disabled
3033 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3035 yes | yes | yes | yes
3036 Arguments : none
3037
3038 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3039 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3040 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3041 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3042 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3043 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3044 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3045
3046 See also : "enabled"
3047
3048
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003049dispatch <address>:<port>
3050 Set a default server address
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003053 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003054
3055 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3056 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3057 during start-up.
3058
3059 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3060 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3061 possible with normal servers.
3062
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003063 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003064 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3065 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3066 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3067 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3068
3069 See also : "server"
3070
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003071
3072dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3073 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | no | yes | yes
3076 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3077
3078 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3079 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3080 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3081 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3082 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3083 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003084
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003085enabled
3086 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3088 yes | yes | yes | yes
3089 Arguments : none
3090
3091 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3092 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3093
3094 See also : "disabled"
3095
3096
3097errorfile <code> <file>
3098 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3100 yes | yes | yes | yes
3101 Arguments :
3102 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003103 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3104 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105
3106 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003107 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003109 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3110 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111
3112 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3113 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3114 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3115
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003116 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3117
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003118 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3119 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3120 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3121 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3122
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003123 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3124 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3125 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3126 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3127 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3128 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3131 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3132 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003133 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3135
3136 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3137
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003138 Example :
3139 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003140 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003141 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3142 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3143
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003144
3145errorloc <code> <url>
3146errorloc302 <code> <url>
3147 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3149 yes | yes | yes | yes
3150 Arguments :
3151 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003152 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003153
3154 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3155 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3156 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3157 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3158 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3159
3160 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3161 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3162 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3163
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003164 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3165
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003166 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3167 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3168 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3169 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003170 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003171 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3172 request.
3173
3174 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3175
3176
3177errorloc303 <code> <url>
3178 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3180 yes | yes | yes | yes
3181 Arguments :
3182 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3183 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3184
3185 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3186 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3187 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3188 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3189 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3190
3191 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3192 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3193 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3194
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003195 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003197 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3198 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3199 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3200 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003201 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003202
3203 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3204
3205
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003206email-alert from <emailaddr>
3207 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3208 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3209 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3210 yes | yes | yes | yes
3211
3212 Arguments :
3213
3214 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3215
3216 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3217 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3218
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003219 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003220 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3221 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003222
3223
3224email-alert level <level>
3225 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3226 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3228 yes | yes | yes | yes
3229
3230 Arguments :
3231
3232 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3233 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3234 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3235
3236 By default level is alert
3237
3238 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3239 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3240 for the proxy.
3241
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003242 Alerts are sent when :
3243
3244 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3245 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3246 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3247 is notice or lower
3248 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3249 and a health check status update occurs
3250
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003251 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3252 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003253 section 3.6 about mailers.
3254
3255
3256email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3257 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3259 yes | yes | yes | yes
3260
3261 Arguments :
3262
3263 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3264
3265 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3266 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3267
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003268 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3269 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003270
3271
3272email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3273 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3274 mailers.
3275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3276 yes | yes | yes | yes
3277
3278 Arguments :
3279
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003280 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003281
3282 By default the systems hostname is used.
3283
3284 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3285 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3286 for the proxy.
3287
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003288 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3289 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003290
3291
3292email-alert to <emailaddr>
3293 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3294 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3296 yes | yes | yes | yes
3297
3298 Arguments :
3299
3300 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3301
3302 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3303 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3304
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003305 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003306 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3307
3308
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003309force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3310 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3311 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3312 no | yes | yes | yes
3313
3314 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3315 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3316 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3317 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3318 marked down for maintenance operations.
3319
3320 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3321 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3322 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3323 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3324 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3325 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3326 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3327 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3328 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3329
3330 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3331 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3332 is used.
3333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003334 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003335 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003336
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003337
3338filter <name> [param*]
3339 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3341 no | yes | yes | yes
3342 Arguments :
3343 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3344 referenced in section 9.
3345
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003346 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003347 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003348 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3349 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003350
3351 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3352 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3353
3354 Example:
3355 listen
3356 bind *:80
3357
3358 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3359 filter compression
3360 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3361
3362 compression algo gzip
3363 compression offload
3364
3365 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3366
3367 See also : section 9.
3368
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003369
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003370fullconn <conns>
3371 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | no | yes | yes
3374 Arguments :
3375 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3376 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3377
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003378 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003379 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003380 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003381 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3382 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3383 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3384 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3385 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003386 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003387
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003388 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3389 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003390 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3391 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3392 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003393
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394 Example :
3395 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3396 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3397 # connections.
3398 backend dynamic
3399 fullconn 10000
3400 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3401 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3402
3403 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3404
3405
3406grace <time>
3407 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003409 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003410 Arguments :
3411 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3412 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3413 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3414
3415 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3416 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003417 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003418 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3419
3420 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3421 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3422 simplify it.
3423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003425hash-balance-factor <factor>
3426 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 yes | no | no | yes
3429 Arguments :
3430 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3431 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3432 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3433
3434 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3435 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3436 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3437 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3438 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3439 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3440 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3441
3442 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3443 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3444 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3445 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3446 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3447
3448 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3449
3450
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003451hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003452 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3454 yes | no | yes | yes
3455 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003456 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3457 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003458
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003459 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3460 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3461 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3462 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3463 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3464 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3465 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3466 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3467 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3468 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003469
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003470 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3471 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3472 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3473 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3474 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3475 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3476 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3477 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3478 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3479 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3480 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3481 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3482 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003483 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3484 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003485
3486 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003488 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003489 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3490 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3491 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003492 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3493 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3494 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003495
3496 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3497 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003498 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3499 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3500 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3501 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3502
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003503 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3504 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3505 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3506 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3507 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3508 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3509 parameter.
3510
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003511 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3512 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3513 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3514 used on strings.
3515
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003516 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3517
3518 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3519 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3520 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3521 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3522 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3523 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3524 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3525 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3526 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3527 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3528 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3529 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003530
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003531 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3532 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3533 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003534
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003535 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003536
3537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003538http-check disable-on-404
3539 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003541 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003542 Arguments : none
3543
3544 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3545 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3546 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3547 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3548 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3549 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3550 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3551 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003552 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3553 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3554 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3555
3556 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3557
3558
3559http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003560 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003562 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003563 Arguments :
3564 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3565 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003566 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003567 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3568 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3569 details on the supported keywords.
3570
3571 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3572 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3573 with the usual backslash ('\').
3574
3575 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3576 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3577 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3578 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3579 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3580
3581 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003582 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003583 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3584 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3585 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3586
3587 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3590 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3591 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3592 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3593
3594 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003596 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3597 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3598 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3599 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3600 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3601 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3602 trace).
3603
3604 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003605 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003606 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3607 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3608 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3609 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3610 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3611 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3612
3613 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3614 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3615 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3616 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3617 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3618 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3619 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3620 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3621
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003622 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3623 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3624 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3625
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003626 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3627 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3628
3629 Examples :
3630 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003631 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003632
3633 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003634 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003635
3636 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003637 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003638
3639 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003640 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003641
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003642 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003643
3644
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003645http-check send-state
3646 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3648 yes | no | yes | yes
3649 Arguments : none
3650
3651 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3652 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3653 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3654 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3655 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3656
3657 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3658 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3659 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3660 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3661 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003662 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3663 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3664 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3665
3666 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3667 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3668 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3669
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003670 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3671 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3672 checked in multiple backends.
3673
3674 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3675 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3676
3677 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3678 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3679 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3680 one fails.
3681
3682 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3683 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3684 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3685
3686 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3687 server's queue.
3688
3689 Example of a header received by the application server :
3690 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3691 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3692
3693 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3694
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003695http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3696 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003697 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003698 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003699 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003700 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3701 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003702 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3703 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003704 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3705 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3706 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003707 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003708 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003709 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003710 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003711 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003712 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003713 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003714 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003715 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003716 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3717
3718 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3719 no | yes | yes | yes
3720
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003721 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3722 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3723 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3724 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3725 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003726
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003727 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3728 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3729 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3730
3731 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003732 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3733 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3734 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3735 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003736
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003737 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3738 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3739 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003740 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3741 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003742 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3743 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3744 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3745 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3746 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003747 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003748 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3749 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003750
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003751 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3752 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3753 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3754 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3755 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3756
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003757 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3758 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3759 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003760 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3761 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003762
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003763 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3764 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3765 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3766 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3767 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3768 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3769 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3770 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3771
3772 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3773 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3774 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003775 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3776 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003777
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003778 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3779 <name>.
3780
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003781 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3782 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3783 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3784 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3785 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3786 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3787 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3788 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3789
3790 Example:
3791
3792 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3793
3794 applied to:
3795
3796 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3797
3798 outputs:
3799
3800 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3801
3802 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3803
3804 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3805 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3806 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3807 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3808 header.
3809
3810 Example:
3811
3812 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3813
3814 applied to:
3815
3816 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3817
3818 outputs:
3819
3820 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3821
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003822 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3823 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3824 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3825 it.
3826
3827 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3828 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3829 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3830 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3831 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3832 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3833
3834 Example :
3835 # prepend the host name before the path
3836 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3837
3838 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3839 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3840 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3841 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3842 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3843 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3844 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3845 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3846
3847 Example :
3848 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3849 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3850
3851 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3852 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3853 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3854 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3855 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3856 "set-query".
3857
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003858 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3859 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3860 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3861 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3862 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3863 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3864 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3865 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3866
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003867 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3868 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3869 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3870 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3871 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3872 another equipment.
3873
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003874 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3875 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3876 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3877 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3878 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3879 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3880 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3881 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3882
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003883 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3884 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3885 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3886 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3887 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3888 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3889 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3890 admin privileges.
3891
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003892 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3893 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3894 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3895 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3896 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3897 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3898 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3899 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3900
3901 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3902 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3903 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3904 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3905 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3906 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3907
3908 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3909 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3910 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3911 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3912 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3913 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3914
3915 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3916 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3917 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3918 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3919 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3920 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3921 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3922 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3923 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3924
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003925 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003926 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3927 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3928 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3929 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3930 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3931 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3932 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3933 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3934 request header" for more information.
3935
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003936 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3937 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3938 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3939 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003940 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3941 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003942
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003943 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3944 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3945 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3946 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3947 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3948 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3949 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3950 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3951 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3952 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3953 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3954 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3955
3956 These actions take one or two arguments :
3957 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3958 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3959 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3960 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3961
3962 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3963 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3964 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3965 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3966
3967 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3968 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3969 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3970 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3971 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3972 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3973 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3974 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3975
3976 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3977 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3978 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3979 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3980 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3981
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003982 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3983 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3984 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3985 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3986 continues.
3987
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003988 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3989 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3990 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3991 the actions evaluation continues.
3992
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003993 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3994 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3995 inline.
3996
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003997 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3998 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003999 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004000 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4001 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004002 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004003 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004004 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004005 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4006 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004007 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004008 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004009 and '_'.
4010
4011 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4012 followed by some converters.
4013
4014 Example:
4015
4016 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4017
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004018 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4019 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4020
4021 Example:
4022
4023 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4024
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004025 - set-src <expr> :
4026 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4027 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4028 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4029 source IP for privacy.
4030
4031 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4032 followed by some converters.
4033
4034 Example:
4035
4036 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4037 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4038
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004039 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4040 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004041
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004042 - set-src-port <expr> :
4043 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4044 expression.
4045
4046 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4047 followed by some converters.
4048
4049 Example:
4050
4051 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4052 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4053
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004054 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4055 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4056 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004057
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004058 - set-dst <expr> :
4059 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4060 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4061 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4062 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4063 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4064
4065 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4066 followed by some converters.
4067
4068 Example:
4069
4070 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4071 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4072
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004073 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4074 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4075
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004076 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4077 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4078 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4079 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4080
4081 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4082 followed by some converters.
4083
4084 Example:
4085
4086 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4087 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4088
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004089 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4090 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4091 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4092
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004093 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4094 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4095 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4096 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4097 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4098 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4099 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4100 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4101 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4102 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4103 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4104 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4105 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4106 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4107 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4108 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4109
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004110 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4111
4112 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4113 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004114 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4115 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4116
4117 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4118 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4119 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4120 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004121
4122 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004123 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4124 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4125 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004126
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004127 http-request allow if nagios
4128 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4129 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4130 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004131
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004132 Example:
4133 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004134 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004135
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004136 Example:
4137 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4138 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004140 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4142 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4143 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4144 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4145 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4146
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004147 Example:
4148 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4149 acl add path /addacl
4150 acl del path /delacl
4151
4152 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4153
4154 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4155 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4156
4157 Example:
4158 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4159 acl setmap path /setmap
4160 acl delmap path /delmap
4161
4162 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4163
4164 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4165 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4166
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004167 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4168 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004169
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004170http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004171 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004172 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004173 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4174 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004175 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004176 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4177 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4178 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4179 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004180 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004181 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004182 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004183 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004184 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004185 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004186 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004187 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004188 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004189 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4190
4191 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4192 no | yes | yes | yes
4193
4194 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4195 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4196 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4197 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4198 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4199 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4200
4201 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4202 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4203 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4204 current section.
4205
4206 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4207 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4208 rules are evaluated.
4209
4210 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4211 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4212 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4213 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4214 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4215 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4216 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4217
4218 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4219 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4220 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4221 external users.
4222
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004223 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4224 <name>.
4225
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004226 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4227 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4228 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4229 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4230 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4231 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4232 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4233 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4234
4235 Example:
4236
4237 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4238
4239 applied to:
4240
4241 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4242
4243 outputs:
4244
4245 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4246
4247 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4248
4249 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4250 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4251 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4252 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4253 header.
4254
4255 Example:
4256
4257 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4258
4259 applied to:
4260
4261 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4262
4263 outputs:
4264
4265 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4266
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004267 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004268 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4269 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4270 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004271
4272 Example:
4273
4274 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4275 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004276 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4277 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004278
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004279 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4280 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4281 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4282 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4283 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4284 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4285 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4286 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4287
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004288 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4289 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4290 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4291 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4292 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4293 another equipment.
4294
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004295 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4296 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4297 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4298 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4299 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4300 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4301 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4302 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4303
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004304 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4305 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4306 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4307 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4308 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4309 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4310 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4311 admin privileges.
4312
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004313 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4314 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4315 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4316 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4317 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4318 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4319 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4320 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4321
4322 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4323 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4324 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4325 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4326 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4327 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4328
4329 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4330 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4331 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4332 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4333 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4334 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4335
4336 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4337 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4338 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4339 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4340 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4341 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4342 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4343 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4344 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4345
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004346 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4347 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4348 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4349 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4350 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4351 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4352 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4353 response header" for more information.
4354
4355 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4356 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4357 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4358 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4359 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004360 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4361 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004362
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004363 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4364 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4365 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4366 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4367 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4368 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4369
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004370 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4371 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4372 inline.
4373
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004374 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4375 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004376 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004377 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4378 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004379 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004380 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004381 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004382 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4383 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004384 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004385 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4386 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004387
4388 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4389 followed by some converters.
4390
4391 Example:
4392
4393 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4394
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004395 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4396 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4397
4398 Example:
4399
4400 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4401
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004402 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4403 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4404 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4405 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4406 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4407 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4408 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4409
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004410 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4411 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4412 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4413 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4414 continues.
4415
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004416 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4417 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4418 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4419 the actions evaluation continues.
4420
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004421 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4422 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4423 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4424 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4425 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4426 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4427 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4428 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4429 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4430 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4431 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4432 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4433 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4434 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4435 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4436 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4437
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004438 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4439
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004440 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004441 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4442 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004443 rules.
4444
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004445 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4446 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4447 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4448 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4449
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004450 Example:
4451 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4452
4453 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4454
4455 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4456 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4457
4458 Example:
4459 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4460
4461 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4462
4463 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4464 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4465
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004466 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4467 ACL usage.
4468
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004469
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004470http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4471 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4472
4473 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4474 yes | no | yes | yes
4475
4476 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4477 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4478 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4479 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4480 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4481 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4482
4483 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4484
4485 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4486 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4487 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4488 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4489 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4490 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4491 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4492 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4493 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4494 not checking any request past the first one.
4495
4496 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4497 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4498 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4499 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4500 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4501 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4502 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4503
4504 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4505 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4506 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4507 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4508 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4509 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4510 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4511 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4512 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4513 downsides of rare connection failures.
4514
4515 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4516 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4517 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4518 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4519 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4520 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4521 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4522 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4523 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4524 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4525 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4526 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4527
4528 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4529 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4530 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4531 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4532
4533 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4534 and are never shared ;
4535
4536 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4537 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4538 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4539 and are never shared ;
4540
4541 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4542 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4543 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4544
4545 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4546 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4547 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4548
4549 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4550
4551
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004552http-send-name-header [<header>]
4553 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4554
4555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4556 yes | no | yes | yes
4557
4558 Arguments :
4559
4560 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4561
4562 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4563 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4564 is added with the header string proved.
4565
4566 See also : "server"
4567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004568id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004569 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4571 no | yes | yes | yes
4572 Arguments : none
4573
4574 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4575 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4576 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004577
4578
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004579ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4580 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4582 no | yes | yes | yes
4583
4584 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4585 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4586 and running).
4587
4588 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4589 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4590 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004591 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004592 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4593
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004594 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4595 "unless" condition is met.
4596
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004597 Example:
4598 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4599 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4600 ignore-persist if url_static
4601
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004602 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4603
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004604load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4605 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4607 yes | no | yes | yes
4608
4609 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4610 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4611 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4612 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4613 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4614 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4615 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4616 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4617
4618 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4619 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004620 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004621
4622 Arguments:
4623 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4624 named "server-state-file".
4625
4626 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4627 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4628 name is used as a file name.
4629
4630 none don't load any stat for this backend
4631
4632 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004633 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4634 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4635 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4636 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4637 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004638
4639 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4640 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4641
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004642 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004643
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004644 global
4645 stats socket /tmp/socket
4646 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004647
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004648 defaults
4649 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004650
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004651 backend bk
4652 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4653 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004654
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004655
4656 Then one can run :
4657
4658 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4659
4660 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4661
4662 1
4663 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4664 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4665 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4666
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004667 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004668
4669 global
4670 stats socket /tmp/socket
4671 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4672
4673 defaults
4674 load-server-state-from-file local
4675
4676 backend bk
4677 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4678 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004680
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004681 Then one can run :
4682
4683 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4684
4685 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4686
4687 1
4688 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4689 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4690 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4691
4692 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4693 "show servers state"
4694
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004695
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004696log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004697log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004698no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004699 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4701 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004702
4703 Prefix :
4704 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4705 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4706 prefix does not allow arguments.
4707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004708 Arguments :
4709 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4710 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4711 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4712 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4713 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4714 parameter.
4715
4716 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4717 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4718
4719 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4720 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4721 standard syslog port).
4722
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004723 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4724 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4725 standard syslog port).
4726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004727 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4728 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4729 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4730 appropriately writeable).
4731
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004732 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4733 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004734
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004735 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4736 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4737 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4738 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4739 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4740 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4741 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4742 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4743 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4744 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4745 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4746
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004747 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4748
4749 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4750 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4751 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4752
4753 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4754 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4755 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004756 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4757 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4758 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4759 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4760 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004761
4762 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4763
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004764 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4765 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4766 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004767
4768 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4769 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4770 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4771 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4772
4773 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4774 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775
4776 Example :
4777 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004778 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4779 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004780 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004781
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004782
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004783log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004784 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4785 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4786 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004787
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004788 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4789 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4790 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4791 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4792 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004793
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004794 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4795 "option httplog" directives.
4796
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004797log-format-sd <string>
4798 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4799 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | no
4801
4802 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4803 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4804 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4805 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4806 which covers the log format string in depth.
4807
4808 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4809 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4810
4811 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4812 log format to "rfc5424".
4813
4814 Example :
4815 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4816
4817
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004818log-tag <string>
4819 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4820 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | yes | yes | yes
4822
4823 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4824 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4825 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4826 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4827 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4828 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4829 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4830 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4831 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004832
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004833max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4834 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4836 yes | no | yes | yes
4837
4838 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4839 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4840 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4841 servers.
4842
4843 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4844 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4845 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4846 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4847 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4848 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4849 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4850 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4851 picking a different server.
4852
4853 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4854 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4855 even if they have to be queued.
4856
4857 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4858 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4859
4860
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004861maxconn <conns>
4862 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | yes | yes | no
4865 Arguments :
4866 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4867 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4868 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4869 closes.
4870
4871 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4872 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4873 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4874 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004875 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4876 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4877 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4878 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879
4880 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4881 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4882 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4883
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004884 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4885
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004886 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4887
4888
4889mode { tcp|http|health }
4890 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4892 yes | yes | yes | yes
4893 Arguments :
4894 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4895 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4896 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4897 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4898
4899 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4900 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4901 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4902 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4903 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4904
4905 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004906 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4907 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4908 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4909 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4910 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4911 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4912 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004913
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004914 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4915 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4916 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004917
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004918 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919 defaults http_instances
4920 mode http
4921
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004922 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004923
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004924
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004925monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4928 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004929 Arguments :
4930 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4931 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004932 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004933 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4934 backend and its backup.
4935
4936 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4937 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4938 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4939 servers in a list of backends.
4940
4941 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4942 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4943 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4944 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4945 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4946 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4947 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004948 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4949 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004950
4951 Example:
4952 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004954 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4955 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4956 monitor-uri /site_alive
4957 monitor fail if site_dead
4958
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004959 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004960
4961
4962monitor-net <source>
4963 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | yes | yes | no
4966 Arguments :
4967 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4968 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4969 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4970 followed by a mask.
4971
4972 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4973 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004974 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004975 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4976
4977 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4978 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4979 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4980 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004981 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4982 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4983 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004984
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004985 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4986 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4987 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4988 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4989 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4990 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004991
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004992 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4993 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995 Example :
4996 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4997 frontend www
4998 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4999
5000 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5001
5002
5003monitor-uri <uri>
5004 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5006 yes | yes | yes | no
5007 Arguments :
5008 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5009 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5010
5011 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5012 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5013 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5014 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5015 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5016 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5017 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5018 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5019
5020 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5021 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5022 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5023 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5024 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5025 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5026
5027 Example :
5028 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5029 frontend www
5030 mode http
5031 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5032
5033 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005035
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005036option abortonclose
5037no option abortonclose
5038 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5040 yes | no | yes | yes
5041 Arguments : none
5042
5043 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5044 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5045 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5046 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005047 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005048 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5049 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5050 encountered while delivering the response.
5051
5052 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5053 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5054 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5055 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5056 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5057 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005058 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005059 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005060 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005061 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5062 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5063 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5064
5065 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5066 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5067 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5068 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5069 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5070 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5071 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5072 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005073 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005074
5075 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5076 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5077
5078 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5079
5080
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005081option accept-invalid-http-request
5082no option accept-invalid-http-request
5083 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 yes | yes | yes | no
5086 Arguments : none
5087
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005088 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005089 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5090 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5091 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5092 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5093 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5094 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5095 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005096 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5097 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5098 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5099 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5100 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005101 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005102 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5103 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5104 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005105
5106 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5107 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5108 been confirmed.
5109
5110 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5111 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005112 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5113 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005114 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5115
5116 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5117 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5118
5119 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5120 stats socket.
5121
5122
5123option accept-invalid-http-response
5124no option accept-invalid-http-response
5125 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | no | yes | yes
5128 Arguments : none
5129
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005130 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005131 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5132 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5133 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5134 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5135 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5136 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5137 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005138 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5139 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5140 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005141
5142 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5143 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5144 been confirmed.
5145
5146 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5147 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5148 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5149 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5150
5151 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5152 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5153
5154 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5155 stats socket.
5156
5157
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005158option allbackups
5159no option allbackups
5160 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5162 yes | no | yes | yes
5163 Arguments : none
5164
5165 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5166 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5167 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5168 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5169 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5170 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5171 order between the backup servers anymore.
5172
5173 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5174 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5175
5176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5178
5179
5180option checkcache
5181no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005182 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5184 yes | no | yes | yes
5185 Arguments : none
5186
5187 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5188 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005189 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005190 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5191 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005192 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005193
5194 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005195 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005196 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005197 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5198 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005199 to the client are :
5200 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005201 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005202 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005203 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5204 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5205 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5206 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5207 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5208 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5209 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5210 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5211 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5212 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5213 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5214
5215 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005216 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005217 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005218 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005219 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5220
5221 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5222 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005223 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005224 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5225
5226 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5227 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5228
5229
5230option clitcpka
5231no option clitcpka
5232 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | yes | yes | no
5235 Arguments : none
5236
5237 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5238 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5239 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5240 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5241
5242 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5243 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5244 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5245 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5246
5247 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5248 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5249 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5250 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5251 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5252
5253 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5254
5255 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5256 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5257 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5258
5259 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5260 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5261
5262 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5263
5264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005265option contstats
5266 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | yes | yes | no
5269 Arguments : none
5270
5271 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5272 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5273 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5274 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005275 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5276 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5277 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5278 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5279 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005280
5281
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005282option dontlog-normal
5283no option dontlog-normal
5284 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | yes | yes | no
5287 Arguments : none
5288
5289 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5290 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5291 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5292 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5293 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5294 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5295 logged.
5296
5297 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5298 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5299 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005301 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005302 logging.
5303
5304
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005305option dontlognull
5306no option dontlognull
5307 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5309 yes | yes | yes | no
5310 Arguments : none
5311
5312 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5313 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5314 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5315 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5316 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5317 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005318 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5319 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5320 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005321
5322 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5323 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5324 would not be logged.
5325
5326 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5327 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5328
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005329 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5330 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331
5332
5333option forceclose
5334no option forceclose
5335 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005337 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005338 Arguments : none
5339
5340 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5341 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5342 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5343 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5344 global session times in the logs.
5345
5346 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005347 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005348 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005349
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005350 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5351 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5352 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5353
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005354 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5355 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005356
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5359
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005360 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005361
5362
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005363option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005364 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5366 yes | yes | yes | yes
5367 Arguments :
5368 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5369 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005370 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005371 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005372
5373 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5374 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5375 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5376 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5377 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5378 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5379 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005380 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5381 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5382 possible that the client has already brought one.
5383
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005384 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005385 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005386 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5387 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005388 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5389 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005390
5391 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5392 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5393 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5394 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5395 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5396 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5397 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5398
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005399 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5400 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5401 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5402 are under the control of the end-user.
5403
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005404 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005405 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5406 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005407 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5408 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5409 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005410
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005411 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005412 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5413 frontend www
5414 mode http
5415 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5416
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005417 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5418 backend www
5419 mode http
5420 option forwardfor header X-Client
5421
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005422 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005423 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005424
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005425
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005426option http-buffer-request
5427no option http-buffer-request
5428 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5430 yes | yes | yes | yes
5431 Arguments : none
5432
5433 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5434 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5435 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5436 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5437 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5438 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5439 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5440 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005441 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005442 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5443 default.
5444
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005445 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005446
5447
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005448option http-ignore-probes
5449no option http-ignore-probes
5450 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 yes | yes | yes | no
5453 Arguments : none
5454
5455 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5456 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5457 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5458 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5459 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5460 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5461 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5462 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5463 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5464 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5465 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5466 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5467
5468 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5469 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5470 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5471 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5472 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5473 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5474 are often the only way to detect them.
5475
5476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5478
5479 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5480
5481
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005482option http-keep-alive
5483no option http-keep-alive
5484 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | yes | yes | yes
5487 Arguments : none
5488
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005489 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5490 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5491 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5492 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5493 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5494 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5495 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5496
5497 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5498 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005499 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5500 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5501 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5502 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5503 situations where this option may be useful :
5504
5505 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5506 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5507
5508 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5509 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5510
5511 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5512 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5513 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5514 request.
5515
5516 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5517 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005518 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5519 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5520 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005521
5522 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5523 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5524
5525 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5526 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5527 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5528 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5529 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5530 not set.
5531
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005532 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5533 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005534 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005535 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005536
5537 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005538 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5539 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005540
5541
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005542option http-no-delay
5543no option http-no-delay
5544 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5546 yes | yes | yes | yes
5547 Arguments : none
5548
5549 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5550 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5551 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5552 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5553 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5554 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5555 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5556 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5557 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5558 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5559 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5560 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5561 affected.
5562
5563 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5564 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5565 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5566 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5567 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5568 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5569 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5570 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5571 latency environments.
5572
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005573 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5574
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005575
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005576option http-pretend-keepalive
5577no option http-pretend-keepalive
5578 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5580 yes | yes | yes | yes
5581 Arguments : none
5582
5583 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5584 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5585 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5586 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5587 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5588 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5589 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5590 consider the response complete.
5591
5592 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5593 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5594 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5595 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5596 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5597 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5598
5599 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5600 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5601 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5602 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5603 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5604 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5605 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5606
5607 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5608 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005609 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005610 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5611 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005612
5613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5615
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005616 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5617 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005618
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005619
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005620option http-server-close
5621no option http-server-close
5622 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | yes | yes | yes
5625 Arguments : none
5626
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005627 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5628 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5629 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5630 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5631 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5632 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5633 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5634 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5635 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5636 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5637 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5638 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5639 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5640 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5641 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5642 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005643
5644 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5645 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5646 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5647 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005648 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5649 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005650
5651 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5652 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005653 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5654 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005655 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5656 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005657
5658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5660
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005661 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005662 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5663 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005664
5665
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005666option http-tunnel
5667no option http-tunnel
5668 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5669 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5670 yes | yes | yes | yes
5671 Arguments : none
5672
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005673 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5674 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5675 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5676 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5677 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5678 "option http-tunnel".
5679
5680 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005681 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005682 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5683 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5684 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5685 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5686 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5687 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5688 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005689
5690 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5691 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5692
5693 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5694 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5695 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5696
5697
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005698option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005699no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005700 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5702 yes | yes | yes | no
5703 Arguments : none
5704
5705 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5706 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5707 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5708 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5709 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5710 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5711 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5712
5713 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5714 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005715 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5716 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5717 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005718
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005719 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5720 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5721 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5722 front of an existing proxy.
5723
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005724 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5725
5726 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5727 http-server-close".
5728
5729
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005730option httpchk
5731option httpchk <uri>
5732option httpchk <method> <uri>
5733option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5734 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 yes | no | yes | yes
5737 Arguments :
5738 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5739 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5740 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5741 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5742 ones.
5743
5744 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5745 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5746 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5747
5748 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5749 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5750 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5751 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5752 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5753
5754 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5755 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5756 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5757 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5758 the lack of any response.
5759
5760 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5761
5762 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5763 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5764 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5765
5766 Examples :
5767 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5768 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5769 backend https_relay
5770 mode tcp
5771 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5772 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5773
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005774 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5775 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5776 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005777
5778
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005779option httpclose
5780no option httpclose
5781 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5783 yes | yes | yes | yes
5784 Arguments : none
5785
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005786 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5787 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5788 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5789 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005790 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005791 "option http-tunnel".
5792
5793 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5794 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5795 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5796 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5797 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5798 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5799 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5800 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005801
5802 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005803 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005804 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5805 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5806 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5807 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5808 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005809
5810 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5811 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005812 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5813 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005814 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5815 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005816
5817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5819
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005820 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5821 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005822
5823
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005824option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005825 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5827 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005828 Arguments :
5829 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5830 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5831 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5832 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5833 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005834
5835 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5836 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5837 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5838 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5839 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5840 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5841 ports.
5842
5843 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5844
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005845 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5846 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005847
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005848 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005850 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005851
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005852
5853option http_proxy
5854no option http_proxy
5855 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | yes | yes | yes
5858 Arguments : none
5859
5860 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5861 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5862 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5863 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5864 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5865
5866 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5867 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005868 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5869 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005870
5871 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5872 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5873
5874 Example :
5875 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5876 backend direct_forward
5877 option httpclose
5878 option http_proxy
5879
5880 See also : "option httpclose"
5881
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005882
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005883option independent-streams
5884no option independent-streams
5885 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5887 yes | yes | yes | yes
5888 Arguments : none
5889
5890 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5891 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5892 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5893 receive data or not.
5894
5895 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5896 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5897 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5898 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5899 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5900 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5901 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5902 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5903 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5904 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5905 socket buffers.
5906
5907 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5908 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5909 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5910 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5911 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5912
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005913 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005914 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5915 deprecated.
5916
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005917 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005918
5919
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005920option ldap-check
5921 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5923 yes | no | yes | yes
5924 Arguments : none
5925
5926 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5927 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5928 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5929 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5930
5931 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5932 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5933
5934 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5935 configure it.
5936
5937 Example :
5938 option ldap-check
5939
5940 See also : "option httpchk"
5941
5942
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005943option external-check
5944 Use external processes for server health checks
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | no | yes | yes
5947
5948 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5949 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5950 command".
5951
5952 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5953
5954 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5955
5956
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005957option log-health-checks
5958no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005959 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5961 yes | no | yes | yes
5962 Arguments : none
5963
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005964 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5965 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5966 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005967
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005968 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5969 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5970 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5971 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5972 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5973
5974 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5975 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005976
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005977 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5978 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5979 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005980
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005981
5982option log-separate-errors
5983no option log-separate-errors
5984 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 yes | yes | yes | no
5987 Arguments : none
5988
5989 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5990 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5991 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5992 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5993 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5994 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5995 provides very important information.
5996
5997 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5998 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5999 error logs.
6000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006001 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006002 logging.
6003
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006004
6005option logasap
6006no option logasap
6007 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6009 yes | yes | yes | no
6010 Arguments : none
6011
6012 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6013 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6014 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6015 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6016 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6017 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6018 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006019 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006020 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6021 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6022
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006023 Examples :
6024 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6025 mode http
6026 option httplog
6027 option logasap
6028 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6029
6030 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6031 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6032 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6033 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006035 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006036 logging.
6037
6038
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006039option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006040 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6042 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006043 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006044 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6045 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006046 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006047
6048 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6049 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6050 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6051 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6052 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6053 in the MySQL table, like this :
6054
6055 USE mysql;
6056 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6057 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6058
6059 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6060 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6061 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6062 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6063 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6064 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6065 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6066 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6067 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6068
6069 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6070 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006071
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006072 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006073
6074 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6075 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6076 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6077 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006078 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6079 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006080
6081 See also: "option httpchk"
6082
6083
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006084option nolinger
6085no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006086 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006087 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006090
6091 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6092 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6093 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6094 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6095 connections.
6096
6097 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6098 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6099 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6100 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6101 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6102 this too.
6103
6104 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6105 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6106 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6107
6108 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6109 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6110 for servers.
6111
6112 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6113 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6114
6115
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006116option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6117 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | yes | yes | yes
6120 Arguments :
6121 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6122 matching <network>
6123 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6124 header name.
6125
6126 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6127 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6128 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6129 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6130 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6131 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6132 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6133 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6134 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6135 possible that the client has already brought one.
6136
6137 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6138 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6139 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6140 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6141 header and requires different one.
6142
6143 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6144 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6145 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6146 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6147 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6148 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6149 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6150
6151 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6152 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6153 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6154 both are defined.
6155
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006156 Examples :
6157 # Original Destination address
6158 frontend www
6159 mode http
6160 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6161
6162 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6163 backend www
6164 mode http
6165 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6166
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006167 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6168 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006169
6170
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006171option persist
6172no option persist
6173 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6175 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006176 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006177
6178 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6179 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6180 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6181 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6182 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6183 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6184 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6185 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6186 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6187 redirected to another valid server.
6188
6189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6191
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006192 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006193
6194
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006195option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6196 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6198 yes | no | yes | yes
6199 Arguments :
6200 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6201 PostgreSQL server.
6202
6203 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6204 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6205 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6206 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6207
6208 See also: "option httpchk"
6209
6210
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006211option prefer-last-server
6212no option prefer-last-server
6213 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6214 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6215 yes | no | yes | yes
6216 Arguments : none
6217
6218 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6219 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6220 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6221 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6222 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6223 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6224 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6225 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6226 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006227 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6228 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6229 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6230 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6231 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6232 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6233 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006234
6235 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6236 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6237
6238 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6239
6240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006241option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006242option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006243no option redispatch
6244 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6245 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6246 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006247 Arguments :
6248 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6249 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6250 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6251 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6252 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6253 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6254 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6255 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6256 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6257
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006258
6259 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6260 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6261 be able to access the service anymore.
6262
6263 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6264 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6265
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006266 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006267 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6268 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006270 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6271 "redisp" keywords.
6272
6273 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6274 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6275
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006276 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006277
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006278
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006279option redis-check
6280 Use redis health checks for server testing
6281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6282 yes | no | yes | yes
6283 Arguments : none
6284
6285 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6286 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6287 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6288 find the "+PONG" response message.
6289
6290 Example :
6291 option redis-check
6292
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006293 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006294
6295
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006296option smtpchk
6297option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6298 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6300 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006301 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006302 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6303 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6304 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6305
6306 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6307 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6308 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6309
6310 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6311 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6312 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6313 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6314 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6315 dead server.
6316
6317 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6318 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6319 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6320 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6321
6322 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6323 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6324 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6325 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006326 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006327
6328 Example :
6329 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6330
6331 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006334option socket-stats
6335no option socket-stats
6336
6337 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6339 yes | yes | yes | no
6340
6341 Arguments : none
6342
6343
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006344option splice-auto
6345no option splice-auto
6346 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6348 yes | yes | yes | yes
6349 Arguments : none
6350
6351 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6352 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6353 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6354 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006355 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006356 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6357 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6358 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6359 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6360
6361 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6362 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6363 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6364 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6365 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6366 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6367 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6368 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6369 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6370 keyword.
6371
6372 Example :
6373 option splice-auto
6374
6375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6377
6378 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6379 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6380
6381
6382option splice-request
6383no option splice-request
6384 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 yes | yes | yes | yes
6387 Arguments : none
6388
6389 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006390 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006391 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6392 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6393 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6394 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6395
6396 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6397
6398 Example :
6399 option splice-request
6400
6401 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6402 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6403
6404 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6405 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6406
6407
6408option splice-response
6409no option splice-response
6410 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6412 yes | yes | yes | yes
6413 Arguments : none
6414
6415 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006416 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006417 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6418 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6419 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6420 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6421
6422 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6423
6424 Example :
6425 option splice-response
6426
6427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6429
6430 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6431 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6432
6433
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006434option spop-check
6435 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6437 no | no | no | yes
6438 Arguments : none
6439
6440 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6441 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6442 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6443 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6444
6445 Example :
6446 option spop-check
6447
6448 See also : "option httpchk"
6449
6450
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006451option srvtcpka
6452no option srvtcpka
6453 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6455 yes | no | yes | yes
6456 Arguments : none
6457
6458 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6459 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6460 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6461 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6462
6463 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6464 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6465 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6466 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6467
6468 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6469 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6470 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6471 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6472 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6473
6474 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6475
6476 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6477 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6478 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6479
6480 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6481 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6482
6483 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6484
6485
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006486option ssl-hello-chk
6487 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6489 yes | no | yes | yes
6490 Arguments : none
6491
6492 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6493 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6494 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6495 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6496 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6497 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6498 hello message.
6499
6500 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6501 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6502 messages, which is appreciable.
6503
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006504 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6505 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6506 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006507
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006508 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6509
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006510
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006511option tcp-check
6512 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6513 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6514 yes | no | yes | yes
6515
6516 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6517 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6518
6519 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6520 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6521 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6522
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006523 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006524 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6525 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6526 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6527 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6528 only.
6529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006530 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006531 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6532 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6533 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6534 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6535
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006536 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006537 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6538 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006539 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006540 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6541 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6542 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6543 the respective protocols.
6544 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6545 analysed.
6546
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006547 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6548 script.
6549
6550 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6551 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6552 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6553 The "comment" is of course optional.
6554
6555
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006556 Examples :
6557 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6558 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006559 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006560
6561 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6562 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006563 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006564
6565 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6566 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006567 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006568 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006569 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006570 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006571 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006572 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006573 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6574 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006575 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006576 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6577 tcp-check expect string +OK
6578
6579 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6580 (send many headers before analyzing)
6581 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006582 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006583 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6584 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6585 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6586 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006587 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006588
6589
6590 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6591
6592
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006593option tcp-smart-accept
6594no option tcp-smart-accept
6595 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6597 yes | yes | yes | no
6598 Arguments : none
6599
6600 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6601 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6602 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6603 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6604 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6605 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6606
6607 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6608 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6609 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6610 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6611
6612 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6613 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6614 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6615 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6616
6617 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6618 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6619 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6620
6621 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6622 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6623 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6624
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006625 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6626
6627
6628option tcp-smart-connect
6629no option tcp-smart-connect
6630 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6632 yes | no | yes | yes
6633 Arguments : none
6634
6635 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6636 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6637 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6638 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6639 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6640
6641 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6642 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6643 complex.
6644
6645 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6646 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6647 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6648
6649 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6650 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6651
6652 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6653
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006654
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006655option tcpka
6656 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | yes | yes | yes
6659 Arguments : none
6660
6661 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6662 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6663 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6664 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6665
6666 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6667 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6668 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6669 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6670
6671 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6672 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6673 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6674 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6675 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6676
6677 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6678
6679 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6680 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6681 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6682 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6683 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6684 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6685 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6686 backends.
6687
6688 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6689
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006690
6691option tcplog
6692 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6694 yes | yes | yes | yes
6695 Arguments : none
6696
6697 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6698 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6699 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6700 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6701 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6702 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6703 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6704 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6705
6706 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6707
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006708 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006710 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006711
6712
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006713option transparent
6714no option transparent
6715 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006717 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006718 Arguments : none
6719
6720 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6721 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6722 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6723 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6724 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6725 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6726 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6727 appropriate server.
6728
6729 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6730 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6731
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006732 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006733 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006734
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006735
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006736external-check command <command>
6737 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6739 yes | no | yes | yes
6740
6741 Arguments :
6742 <command> is the external command to run
6743
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006744 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6745
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006746 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006747
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006748 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6749 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6750 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6751 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6752 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6753 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006754
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006755 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6756
6757 Environment variables :
6758 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6759 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6760
6761 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6762
6763 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6764
6765 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6766 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6767 for a UNIX socket).
6768
6769 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6770
6771 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6772
6773 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6774
6775 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6776
6777 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6778
6779 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6780 socket).
6781
6782 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6783 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6784
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006785 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6786 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6787 failed.
6788
6789 Example :
6790 external-check command /bin/true
6791
6792 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6793
6794
6795external-check path <path>
6796 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6798 yes | no | yes | yes
6799
6800 Arguments :
6801 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6802
6803 The default path is "".
6804
6805 Example :
6806 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6807
6808 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6809 "external-check command"
6810
6811
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006812persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006813persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006814 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6816 yes | no | yes | yes
6817 Arguments :
6818 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006819 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6820 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006821
6822 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6823 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6824 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6825 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6826 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6827 forwarded to this server.
6828
6829 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6830 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6831 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006832 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006833 a single "listen" section.
6834
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006835 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6836 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6837 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6838
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006839 Example :
6840 listen tse-farm
6841 bind :3389
6842 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6843 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6844 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6845 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6846 persist rdp-cookie
6847 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006848 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006849 balance rdp-cookie
6850 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6851 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6852
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006853 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6854 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006855
6856
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006857rate-limit sessions <rate>
6858 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | yes | yes | no
6861 Arguments :
6862 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6863 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6864
6865 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6866 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6867 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6868 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6869 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6870 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6871
6872 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6873 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6874 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6875 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6876
6877 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6878 listen smtp
6879 mode tcp
6880 bind :25
6881 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006882 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006883
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006884 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6885 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6886 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006887
6888 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6889
6890
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006891redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6892redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6893redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006894 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 no | yes | yes | yes
6897
6898 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006899 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006900
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006901 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006902 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006903 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6904 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6905 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006906
6907 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6908 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6909 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6910 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6911 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006912 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6913 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6914 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6915 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006916
6917 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6918 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6919 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6920 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6921 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6922 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006923 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006924 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006925 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6926 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6927 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006928
6929 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006930 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6931 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6932 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006933 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006934 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6935 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6936 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6937 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006938
6939 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6940 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6941
6942 - "drop-query"
6943 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6944 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6945 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6946 with a location-type redirect.
6947
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006948 - "append-slash"
6949 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6950 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6951 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6952 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6953
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006954 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6955 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6956 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6957 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6958 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6959 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6960 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6961
6962 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6963 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6964 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6965 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6966 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6967 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6968 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006969
6970 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6971 acl clear dst_port 80
6972 acl secure dst_port 8080
6973 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006974 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006975 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006976 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6977
6978 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006979 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6980 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6981 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006982 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006983
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006984 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6985 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6986 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6987
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006988 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006989 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006990
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006991 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006992 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6993 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6994 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006995
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006996 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006997
6998
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006999redisp (deprecated)
7000redispatch (deprecated)
7001 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7003 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007004 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007005
7006 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7007 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7008 be able to access the service anymore.
7009
7010 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7011 redistribute them to a working server.
7012
7013 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7014 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7015 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007017 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7018 "option redispatch" instead.
7019
7020 See also : "option redispatch"
7021
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007022
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007023reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007024 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 no | yes | yes | yes
7027 Arguments :
7028 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7029 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007030 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007031
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007032 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7033 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7034
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007035 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7036 the last header of an HTTP request.
7037
7038 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7039 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7040 responses.
7041
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007042 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7043 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7044 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7045
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007046 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7047 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007048
7049
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007050reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7051reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007052 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7054 no | yes | yes | yes
7055 Arguments :
7056 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7057 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7058 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7059 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7060 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7061 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7062 ignores case.
7063
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007064 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7065 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7066
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007067 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7068 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7069 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7070 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007071 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007072
7073 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7074 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7075
7076 Example :
7077 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7078 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7079 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7080
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007081 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7082 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007083
7084
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007085reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7086reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007087 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7089 no | yes | yes | yes
7090 Arguments :
7091 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7092 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7093 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7094 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7095 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7096 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7097
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007098 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7099 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7100
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007101 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7102 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7103 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7104 next servers.
7105
7106 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7107 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7108 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7109
7110 Example :
7111 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7112 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7113 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7114
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007115 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7116 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007117
7118
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007119reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7120reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007121 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7123 no | yes | yes | yes
7124 Arguments :
7125 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7126 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7127 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7128 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7129 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7130 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7131 case.
7132
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007133 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7134 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7135
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007136 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7137 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7138 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7139 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007140 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007141
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007142 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007143 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007144 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007145
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007146 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7147 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7148
7149 Example :
7150 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7151 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7152 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7153
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007154 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7155 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007156
7157
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007158reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7159reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007160 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7162 no | yes | yes | yes
7163 Arguments :
7164 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7165 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7166 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7167 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7168 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7169 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7170 case.
7171
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007172 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7173 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7174
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7176 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7177 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7178 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7179
7180 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7181 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7182
7183 Example :
7184 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7185 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7186 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7187 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7188
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007189 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7190 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007191
7192
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007193reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7194reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007195 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7197 no | yes | yes | yes
7198 Arguments :
7199 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7200 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7201 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7202 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7203 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7204 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7205
7206 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7207 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7208 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7209 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007210 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007211
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007212 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7213 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7214
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007215 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7216 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7217 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7218
7219 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7220 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7221 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7222 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7223 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7224
7225 Example :
7226 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007227 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007228 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7229 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7230
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007231 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7232 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007233
7234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007235reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7236reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007237 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 no | yes | yes | yes
7240 Arguments :
7241 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7242 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7243 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7244 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7245 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7246 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7247 ignores case.
7248
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007249 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7250 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7251
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007252 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7253 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007254 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7255 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7256 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007257 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7258 not set.
7259
7260 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7261 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7262 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7263 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7264 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7265
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007266 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007267 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7268 # block all others.
7269 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7270 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7271
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007272 # block bad guys
7273 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7274 reqitarpit . if badguys
7275
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007276 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7277 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007278
7279
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007280retries <value>
7281 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7282 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7283 yes | no | yes | yes
7284 Arguments :
7285 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7286 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7287 default value is 3.
7288
7289 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7290 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7291 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7292
7293 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007294 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7295 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007296
7297 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7298 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7299
7300 See also : "option redispatch"
7301
7302
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007303rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007304 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7306 no | yes | yes | yes
7307 Arguments :
7308 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7309 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007310 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007311
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007312 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7313 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7314
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007315 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7316 the last header of an HTTP response.
7317
7318 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7319 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7320 responses.
7321
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007322 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7323 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324
7325
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007326rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7327rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007328 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7330 no | yes | yes | yes
7331 Arguments :
7332 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7333 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7334 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7335 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7336 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7337 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7338 ignores case.
7339
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007340 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7341 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7342
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007343 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7344 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007345 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 client.
7347
7348 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7349 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7350 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7351
7352 Example :
7353 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007354 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007356 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7357 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007358
7359
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007360rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7361rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 no | yes | yes | yes
7365 Arguments :
7366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7367 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7368 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7369 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7370 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7371 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7372 ignores case.
7373
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007374 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7375 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7376
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007377 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7378 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7379 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7380 case-sensitive.
7381
7382 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007383 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7384 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7385 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007386
7387 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7388 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7389
7390 Example :
7391 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7392 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7393
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007394 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7395 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007396
7397
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007398rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7399rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007400 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7402 no | yes | yes | yes
7403 Arguments :
7404 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7405 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7406 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7407 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7408 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7409 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7410 ignores case.
7411
7412 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7413 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7414 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7415 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007417
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007418 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7419 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7420
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007421 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7422 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7423 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7424
7425 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7426 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7427 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7428 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7429 are not case-sensitive.
7430
7431 Example :
7432 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7433 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7434
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007435 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7436 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437
7438
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007439server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007440 Declare a server in a backend
7441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 no | no | yes | yes
7443 Arguments :
7444 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007445 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007446 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007447
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007448 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7449 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7450 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7451 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007452 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7453 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7454 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7455 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7456 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007457 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7458 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7459 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7460 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7461 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7462 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7463 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007464 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007465 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7466 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007467 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7468 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007469
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007470 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007471 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7472 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7473 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7474 adding this value to the client's port.
7475
7476 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7477 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007478 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007479
7480 Examples :
7481 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7482 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007483 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007484 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7485 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7486 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007487
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007488 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7489 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7490 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7491 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7492 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7493
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007494 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7495 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007496
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007497server-state-file-name [<file>]
7498 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7499 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7500 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7501 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7502 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7503 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7504
7505 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7506 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7507
7508 global
7509 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7510
7511 backend bk
7512 load-server-state-from-file
7513
7514 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7515 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007516
7517source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007518source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007519source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007520 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7522 yes | no | yes | yes
7523 Arguments :
7524 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7525 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007526
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007527 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007528 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7529 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7530 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7531 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7532 supported prefixes are :
7533 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7534 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7535 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007536 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007537 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7538 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007539
7540 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7541 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007542 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7543 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7544 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007545
7546 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7547 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7548 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7549 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7550 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7551 <addr>.
7552
7553 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7554 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7555 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7556 port.
7557
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007558 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7559 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7560 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7561 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007562 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007563 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7564 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7565 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7566 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7567 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7568 HTTP header.
7569
7570 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7571 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007572 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007573 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7574 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7575 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7576 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7577 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7578 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7579 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7580
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007581 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7582 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7583 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7584 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7585 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7586 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7587
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007588 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7589 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7590 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7591 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7592
7593 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7594 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7595 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7596 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7597 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7598 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7599
7600 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7601 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7602 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7603 there are two methods :
7604
7605 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7606 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7607 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7608 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7609 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7610 of the client ranges may be used.
7611
7612 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7613 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7614 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7615 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7616 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7617 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7618 same session.
7619
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007620 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7621 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7622 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007623 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007624
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007625 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7626
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007627 Examples :
7628 backend private
7629 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7630 source 192.168.1.200
7631
7632 backend transparent_ssl1
7633 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7634 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7635
7636 backend transparent_ssl2
7637 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7638 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7639 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7640
7641 backend transparent_ssl3
7642 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7643 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7644 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7645
7646 backend transparent_smtp
7647 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7648 # with Tproxy version 4.
7649 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7650
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007651 backend transparent_http
7652 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7653 # proxy.
7654 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007656 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007657 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007659
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007660srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7661 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7663 yes | no | yes | yes
7664 Arguments :
7665 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7666 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7667 as explained at the top of this document.
7668
7669 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7670 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7671 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7672 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7673 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7674 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7675 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7676
7677 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7678 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7679 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7680 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7681 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007682 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007683 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007684 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007685
7686 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7687 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7688 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7689 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7690 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7691 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7692
7693 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7694 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7695
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007696 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7697 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007698
7699
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007700stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7701 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007703 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007704
7705 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7706 matched.
7707
7708 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7709 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7710
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007711 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7712 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7713 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7714
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007715 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7716 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7717 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7718 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007719
7720 Example :
7721 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7722 backend stats_localhost
7723 stats enable
7724 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7725
7726 Example :
7727 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7728 backend stats_auth
7729 stats enable
7730 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7731 stats admin if TRUE
7732
7733 Example :
7734 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7735 userlist stats-auth
7736 group admin users admin
7737 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7738 group readonly users haproxy
7739 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7740
7741 backend stats_auth
7742 stats enable
7743 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7744 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7745 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7746 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7747
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007748 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7749 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7750 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007751
7752
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007753stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7754 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007757 Arguments :
7758 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7759
7760 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7761
7762 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7763 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7764 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7765 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7766 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7767 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7768
7769 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7770 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7771 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007772 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007773
7774 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7775 report using "stats scope".
7776
7777 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7778 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7779 unobvious parameters.
7780
7781 Example :
7782 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7783 backend public_www
7784 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7785 stats enable
7786 stats hide-version
7787 stats scope .
7788 stats uri /admin?stats
7789 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7790 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7791 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7792
7793 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7794 backend private_monitoring
7795 stats enable
7796 stats uri /admin?stats
7797 stats refresh 5s
7798
7799 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7800
7801
7802stats enable
7803 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007806 Arguments : none
7807
7808 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7809 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7810 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7811 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7812 - stats auth : no authentication
7813 - stats scope : no restriction
7814
7815 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7816 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7817 unobvious parameters.
7818
7819 Example :
7820 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7821 backend public_www
7822 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7823 stats enable
7824 stats hide-version
7825 stats scope .
7826 stats uri /admin?stats
7827 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7828 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7829 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7830
7831 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7832 backend private_monitoring
7833 stats enable
7834 stats uri /admin?stats
7835 stats refresh 5s
7836
7837 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7838
7839
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007840stats hide-version
7841 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007843 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007844 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007846 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7847 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7848 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7849 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7850 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7851 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007853 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7854 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7855 unobvious parameters.
7856
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007857 Example :
7858 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7859 backend public_www
7860 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007861 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007862 stats hide-version
7863 stats scope .
7864 stats uri /admin?stats
7865 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7866 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7867 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007868
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007869 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7870 backend private_monitoring
7871 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007872 stats uri /admin?stats
7873 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007874
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007875 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007876
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007877
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007878stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7880 Access control for statistics
7881
7882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7883 no | no | yes | yes
7884
7885 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7886 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7887 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7888 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7889 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7890 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7891
7892 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7893 instance.
7894
7895 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7896 about ACL usage.
7897
7898
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007899stats realm <realm>
7900 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007902 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007903 Arguments :
7904 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7905 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7906 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7907
7908 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7909 using a backslash ('\').
7910
7911 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7912 only related to authentication.
7913
7914 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7915 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7916 unobvious parameters.
7917
7918 Example :
7919 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7920 backend public_www
7921 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7922 stats enable
7923 stats hide-version
7924 stats scope .
7925 stats uri /admin?stats
7926 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7927 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7928 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7929
7930 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7931 backend private_monitoring
7932 stats enable
7933 stats uri /admin?stats
7934 stats refresh 5s
7935
7936 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7937
7938
7939stats refresh <delay>
7940 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007942 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007943 Arguments :
7944 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7945 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7946 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7947 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7948 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7949 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7950
7951 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7952 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7953 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7954 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7955
7956 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7957 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7958 unobvious parameters.
7959
7960 Example :
7961 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7962 backend public_www
7963 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7964 stats enable
7965 stats hide-version
7966 stats scope .
7967 stats uri /admin?stats
7968 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7969 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7970 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7971
7972 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7973 backend private_monitoring
7974 stats enable
7975 stats uri /admin?stats
7976 stats refresh 5s
7977
7978 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7979
7980
7981stats scope { <name> | "." }
7982 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007984 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007985 Arguments :
7986 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7987 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7988 section in which the statement appears.
7989
7990 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7991 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7992 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7993 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7994 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7995 exists.
7996
7997 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7998 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7999 unobvious parameters.
8000
8001 Example :
8002 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8003 backend public_www
8004 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8005 stats enable
8006 stats hide-version
8007 stats scope .
8008 stats uri /admin?stats
8009 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8010 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8011 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8012
8013 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8014 backend private_monitoring
8015 stats enable
8016 stats uri /admin?stats
8017 stats refresh 5s
8018
8019 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8020
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008021
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008022stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008023 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008025 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008026
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008027 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008028 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8029
8030 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8031 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8032
8033 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8034 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008035 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008036
8037 Example :
8038 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8039 backend private_monitoring
8040 stats enable
8041 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8042 stats uri /admin?stats
8043 stats refresh 5s
8044
8045 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8046 global section.
8047
8048
8049stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008050 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8052 yes | yes | yes | yes
8053 Arguments : none
8054
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008055 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008056 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8057 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8058 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8059 - IP (socket, server)
8060 - cookie (backend, server)
8061
8062 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8063 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008064 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008065
8066 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8067
8068
8069stats show-node [ <name> ]
8070 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008073 Arguments:
8074 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8075 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8076
8077 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8078 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008079 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008080
8081 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8082 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8083 unobvious parameters.
8084
8085 Example:
8086 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8087 backend private_monitoring
8088 stats enable
8089 stats show-node Europe-1
8090 stats uri /admin?stats
8091 stats refresh 5s
8092
8093 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8094 section.
8095
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008096
8097stats uri <prefix>
8098 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008100 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101 Arguments :
8102 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8103 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8104 query string.
8105
8106 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8107 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8108 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8109 possible to reach it in the application.
8110
8111 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008112 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008113 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8114 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8115 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8116 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8117
8118 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8119 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8120 an address or a port to statistics only.
8121
8122 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8123 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8124 unobvious parameters.
8125
8126 Example :
8127 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8128 backend public_www
8129 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8130 stats enable
8131 stats hide-version
8132 stats scope .
8133 stats uri /admin?stats
8134 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8135 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8136 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8137
8138 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8139 backend private_monitoring
8140 stats enable
8141 stats uri /admin?stats
8142 stats refresh 5s
8143
8144 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8145
8146
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008147stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8148 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008150 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008151
8152 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008153 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008154 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8155 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8156 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8157
8158 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8159 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8160 the "stick-table" statement.
8161
8162 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8163 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8164 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8165 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8166 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8167
8168 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8169 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8170 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8171 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8172 transformation rules.
8173
8174 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8175 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8176 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8177 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8178 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8179 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8180 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8181
8182 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8183 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8184 ACL based conditions.
8185
8186 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8187 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8188 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8189 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8190
8191 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8192 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8193 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8194 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8195
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008196 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8197 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8198 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8199
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008200 Example :
8201 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8202 # last 30 minutes
8203 backend pop
8204 mode tcp
8205 balance roundrobin
8206 stick store-request src
8207 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8208 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8209 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8210
8211 backend smtp
8212 mode tcp
8213 balance roundrobin
8214 stick match src table pop
8215 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8216 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8217
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008218 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008219 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008220
8221
8222stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8223 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8225 no | no | yes | yes
8226
8227 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8228 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8229 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8230 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8231
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008232 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8233 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8234 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8235
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008236 Examples :
8237 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008238 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008239
8240 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8241 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8242 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8243
8244
8245 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8246 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8247 backend http
8248 mode http
8249 balance roundrobin
8250 stick on src table https
8251 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8252 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8253 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8254
8255 backend https
8256 mode tcp
8257 balance roundrobin
8258 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8259 stick on src
8260 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8261 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8262
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008263 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008264
8265
8266stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8267 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 no | no | yes | yes
8270
8271 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008272 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008273 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8274 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8275 server is selected.
8276
8277 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8278 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8279 the "stick-table" statement.
8280
8281 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8282 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8283 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8284 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8285 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8286 address.
8287
8288 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8289 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8290 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8291 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8292 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8293 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8294 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8295 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8296 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8297 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8298
8299 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8300 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8301 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8302 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8303 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8304 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8305 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8306
8307 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8308 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8309 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8310 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8311
8312 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8313 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8314 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8315 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8316 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8317 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008318 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8319 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8320 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8321 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8322 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8323 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008324
8325 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8326 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8327 the request.
8328
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008329 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8330 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8331 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8332
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008333 Example :
8334 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8335 # last 30 minutes
8336 backend pop
8337 mode tcp
8338 balance roundrobin
8339 stick store-request src
8340 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8341 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8342 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8343
8344 backend smtp
8345 mode tcp
8346 balance roundrobin
8347 stick match src table pop
8348 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8349 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8350
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008351 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008352 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008353
8354
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008355stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008356 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8357 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008358 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008360 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008361
8362 Arguments :
8363 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8364 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8365 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8366 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8367
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008368 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8369 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8370 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8371 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8372
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008373 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8374 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8375 instance.
8376
8377 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8378 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8379 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8380 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8381 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8382 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008383 to 32 characters.
8384
8385 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8386 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8387 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008388 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008389 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8390 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008391
8392 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008393 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8394 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008395 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8396 increase.
8397
8398 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008399 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8400 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8401 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008402
8403 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8404 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8405 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8406 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8407 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8408 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8409 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8410 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8411 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8412 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8413 parameter (see below).
8414
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008415 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8416 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8417 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8418 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8419 soft restart.
8420
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008421 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8422 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008423
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008424 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8425 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8426 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8427 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8428 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008429 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008430 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8431 if not expiration delay is specified.
8432
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008433 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8434 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8435 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8436 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008437 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8438 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8439 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8440 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8441 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8442 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8443 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8444 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8445 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8446 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8447 types and their arguments.
8448
8449 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8450 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8451 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8452 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8453
8454 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8455 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8456 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8457 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8458
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008459 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8460 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8461 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8462 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8463 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8464 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8465
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008466 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8467 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8468 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8469 they were received.
8470
8471 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8472 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8473 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8474 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8475 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8476
8477 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8478 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8479 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8480 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8481 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8482
8483 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8484 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8485 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8486
8487 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8488 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8489 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8490 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8491 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8492
8493 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8494 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8495 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8496 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8497 the client side.
8498
8499 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8500 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8501 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8502 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8503 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8504 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8505 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8506
8507 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8508 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8509 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8510 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8511 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8512 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8513 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8514
8515 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8516 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8517 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8518 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8519 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8520 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8521
8522 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8523 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8524 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8525 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8526
8527 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8528 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8529 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8530 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8531 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8532 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8533 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8534 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8535 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8536 recommended for better fairness.
8537
8538 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8539 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8540 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8541 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8542
8543 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8544 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8545 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8546 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8547 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8548 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8549 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8550 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8551 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8552 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008553
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008554 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8555 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008556 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8557 reference it.
8558
8559 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8560 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008561 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8562 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8563 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008564
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008565 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8566 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8567 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8568 something that can be ignored.
8569
8570 Example:
8571 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8572 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8573 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8574 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8575
8576 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008577 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008578
8579
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008580stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008581 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8583 no | no | yes | yes
8584
8585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008586 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008587 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8588 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8589 server is selected.
8590
8591 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8592 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8593 the "stick-table" statement.
8594
8595 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8596 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8597 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8598 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8599
8600 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8601 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8602 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8603 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8604 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8605 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008606 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008607 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8608 rules.
8609
8610 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8611 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8612 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8613 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8614 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8615 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8616 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8617
8618 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8619 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8620 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8621 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8622
8623 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8624 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8625 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8626 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8627 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8628 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008629 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8630 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8631 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8632 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8633 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8634 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8635 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8636 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8637 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008638
8639 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8640
8641 Example :
8642 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8643 backend https
8644 mode tcp
8645 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008646 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008647 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008648
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008649 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8650 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8651
8652 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8653 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8654 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8655
8656 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8657 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008658
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008659 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8660 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8661 # at offset 44.
8662
8663 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8664 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8665
8666 # Learn on response if server hello.
8667 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008668
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008669 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8670 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8671
8672 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8673 extraction.
8674
8675
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008676tcp-check connect [params*]
8677 Opens a new connection
8678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 no | no | yes | yes
8680
8681 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8682 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8683 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8684
8685 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8686 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8687 of the sequence.
8688
8689 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8690 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8691 do.
8692
8693 Parameters :
8694 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8695 use the TCP connection.
8696
8697 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8698 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8699 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8700
8701 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8702
8703 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8704
8705 Examples:
8706 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8707 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8708 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8709 option tcp-check
8710 tcp-check connect
8711 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8712 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8713 tcp-check send \r\n
8714 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8715 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8716 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8717 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8718 tcp-check send \r\n
8719 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8720 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8721
8722 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8723 option tcp-check
8724 tcp-check connect port 110
8725 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8726 tcp-check connect port 143
8727 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8728 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8729
8730 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8731
8732
8733tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8734 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8735 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8736 no | no | yes | yes
8737
8738 Arguments :
8739 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8740 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8741 binary.
8742 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8743 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8744 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8745
8746 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8747 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8748 with the usual backslash ('\').
8749 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8750 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8751 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8752 used upper or lower case.
8753
8754
8755 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8756
8757 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8758 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8759 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8760 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8761 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8762 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8763 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8764 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8765
8766 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8767 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8768 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8769 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8770 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8771 expression.
8772
8773 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8774 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8775 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8776 this exact hexadecimal string.
8777 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8778
8779 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8780 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8781 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8782 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8783 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8784 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8785 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8786 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8787 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8788 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8789 the null character.
8790
8791 Examples :
8792 # perform a POP check
8793 option tcp-check
8794 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8795
8796 # perform an IMAP check
8797 option tcp-check
8798 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8799
8800 # look for the redis master server
8801 option tcp-check
8802 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008803 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008804 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8805 tcp-check expect string role:master
8806 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8807 tcp-check expect string +OK
8808
8809
8810 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8811 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8812
8813
8814tcp-check send <data>
8815 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8817 no | no | yes | yes
8818
8819 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8820 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8821
8822 Examples :
8823 # look for the redis master server
8824 option tcp-check
8825 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8826 tcp-check expect string role:master
8827
8828 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8829 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8830
8831
8832tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8833 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8834 tcp health check
8835 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8836 no | no | yes | yes
8837
8838 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8839 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8840 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8841 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8842 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8843 hexadecimal string.
8844 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8845
8846 Examples :
8847 # redis check in binary
8848 option tcp-check
8849 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8850 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8851
8852
8853 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8854 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8855
8856
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008857tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8858 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8860 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008862 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8863 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008864
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008865 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008866
8867 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8868 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008869 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8870 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8871 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8872 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8873 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8874 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008875
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008876 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8877 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8878 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8879 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008880
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008881 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008882 - accept :
8883 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8884 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8885 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008887 - reject :
8888 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8889 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8890 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8891 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8892 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8893 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8894 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8895 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8896 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8897 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8898 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008899 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008900
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008901 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8902 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8903 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8904 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8905 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8906 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8907 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8908 hosts.
8909
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008910 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8911 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8912 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8913 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8914 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8915 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8916 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8917 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8918
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008919 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8920 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8921 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8922 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8923 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8924 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8925 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8926 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8927 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008928 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8929 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008930
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008931 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008932 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008933 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008934 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008935 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8936 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008937 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008938 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8939 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8940 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8941 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8942 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008944 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008945 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008946 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008947 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8948 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8949 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8950 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008951
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008952 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8953 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8954 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8955 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008956
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008957 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8958 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8959 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8960 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8961 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008962 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8963 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8964 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8965 layer7 information is extracted.
8966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008967 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8968 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8969 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8970 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8971 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008972
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008973 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8974 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8975 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8976 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8977
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008978 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8979 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8980 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8981 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8982 continues.
8983
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008984 - set-src <expr> :
8985 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8986 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8987 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8988 set-src"
8989
8990 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8991 followed by some converters.
8992
8993 Example:
8994
8995 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8996
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008997 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8998 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008999
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009000 - set-src-port <expr> :
9001 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9002 expression.
9003
9004 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9005 followed by some converters.
9006
9007 Example:
9008
9009 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9010
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009011 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9012 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9013 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009014
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009015 - set-dst <expr> :
9016 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9017 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9018 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9019 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9020 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9021
9022 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9023 followed by some converters.
9024
9025 Example:
9026
9027 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9028 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9029
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009030 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9031 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9032
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009033 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9034 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9035 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9036 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9037
9038
9039 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9040 followed by some converters.
9041
9042 Example:
9043
9044 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9045
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009046 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9047 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9048 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9049
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009050 - "silent-drop" :
9051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9052 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9053 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9054 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9055 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9056 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9057 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9058 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9059 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9060 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9061 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9062 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9063 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9064 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9065 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9066 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9067
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009068 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9069 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9070 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009071
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009072 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9073 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9074 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009075
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009076 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009077 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009078 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009079
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009080 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9081 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9082 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009083
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009084 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009085 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9086 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009087
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009088 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9089
9090 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9091
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009092 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9093
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009094 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009095
9096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009097tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9098 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009100 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009101 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009102 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9103 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009105 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009107 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9108 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9109 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9110 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9111 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009113 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9114 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9115 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9116 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009117 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9118 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9119 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9120 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9121 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9122 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009123 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009124 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009125
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009126 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9127 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9128 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9129 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009130
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009131 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009132 - accept : the request is accepted
9133 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9134 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009135 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009136 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009137 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009138 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009139 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009140 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009141
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009142 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9143 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009144
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009145 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9146 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9147 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9148 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9149 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9150 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009152 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009153 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9154 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009156 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009157 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9158 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9159 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9160 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009161 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9162 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9163 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009164
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009165 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009166 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9167 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9168 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009169
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009170 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009171 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9172 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009173
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009174 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9175 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009176 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009177 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9178 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009179 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009180 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009181 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009182 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9183 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009184 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009185 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9186 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009187
9188 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9189 followed by some converters.
9190
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009191 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9192 <var-name>.
9193
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009194 Example:
9195
9196 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009197 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009198
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009199 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009200 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9201 # and reject everything else.
9202 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9203 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009204 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009205 tcp-request content reject
9206
9207 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009208 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9209 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9210 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009211 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009212
9213 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9214 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9215 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009216 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009217 tcp-request content reject
9218
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009219 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009220 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009221 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009222 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009223 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9224 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009225
9226 Example:
9227 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9228 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009229 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009231 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009232 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009233
9234 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009235 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009236 # protecting all our sites
9237 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009238 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9239 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009240 ...
9241 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9242
9243 backend http_dynamic
9244 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009245 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009246 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009247 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009248 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009249 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009250 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009252 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009253
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009254 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9255 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009256
9257
9258tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9259 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009261 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009262 Arguments :
9263 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9264 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9265 as explained at the top of this document.
9266
9267 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9268 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9269 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9270 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9271 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9272
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009273 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9274 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9275 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9276 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9277
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009278 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9279 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009280 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009281 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009282 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9283 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9284 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9285 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009286
9287 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9288 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9289 it pass through unaffected.
9290
9291 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9292 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9293 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009294 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009295 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9296 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009297 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9298 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9299 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009300
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009301 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302 "timeout client".
9303
9304
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009305tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9306 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9308 no | no | yes | yes
9309 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009310 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9311 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009312
9313 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9314
9315 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9316 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9317 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009318 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9319 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009320
9321 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9322
9323 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9324 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9325 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9326 inserted.
9327
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009328 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009329 - accept :
9330 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9331 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9332 the rules evaluation.
9333
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009334 - close :
9335 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9336 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9337 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9338 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9339 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9340 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009341 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009342 protocols.
9343
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009344 - reject :
9345 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9346 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009347 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009348
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009349 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9350 Sets a variable.
9351
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009352 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9353 Unsets a variable.
9354
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009355 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9356 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9357 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9358 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9359
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009360 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9361 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9362 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9363 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9364 continues.
9365
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009366 - "silent-drop" :
9367 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9368 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9369 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9370 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9371 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9372 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9373 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9374 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9375 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9376 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9377 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9378 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9379 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9380 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9381 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9382 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9383
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009384 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9385 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9386 for changing the default action to a reject.
9387
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009388 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9389 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9390 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9391 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009392 period.
9393
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009394 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9395 declared inline.
9396
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009397 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9398 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009399 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009400 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9401 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009402 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009403 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009404 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009405 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9406 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009407 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009408 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9409 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009410
9411 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9412 followed by some converters.
9413
9414 Example:
9415
9416 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9417
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009418 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9419 <var-name>.
9420
9421 Example:
9422
9423 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9424
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009425 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9426
9427 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9428
9429
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009430tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9431 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9433 no | yes | yes | no
9434 Arguments :
9435 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9436 below.
9437
9438 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9439
9440 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9441 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9442 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9443 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9444 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9445 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9446 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9447 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9448 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9449 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9450 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9451 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9452 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9453 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9454 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9455 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9456 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9457 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9458 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9459 instead.
9460
9461 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9462 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9463 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9464 rules which may be inserted.
9465
9466 Several types of actions are supported :
9467 - accept : the request is accepted
9468 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9469 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9470 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9471 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9472 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009473 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009474 - silent-drop
9475
9476 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9477 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9478 sections for a complete description.
9479
9480 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9481 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9482 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9483
9484 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9485 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9486 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9487 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9488 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9489
9490 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9491 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9492
9493 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9494 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9495 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9496
9497 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9498 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9499 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9500
9501 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9502 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9503 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9504
9505 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9506 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9507 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9508
9509 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9510
9511 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9512
9513
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009514tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9515 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9517 no | no | yes | yes
9518 Arguments :
9519 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9520 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9521 as explained at the top of this document.
9522
9523 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9524
9525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009526timeout check <timeout>
9527 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9528 established.
9529
9530 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9531 yes | no | yes | yes
9532 Arguments:
9533 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9534 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9535 as explained at the top of this document.
9536
9537 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9538 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9539 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9540 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009541 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9542 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9543 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009544
9545 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9546 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9547
9548 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9549 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009550 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009551
9552 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9553 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9554 forget about it.
9555
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009556 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9557 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009558
9559
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009560timeout client <timeout>
9561timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9562 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9564 yes | yes | yes | no
9565 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009566 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009567 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9568 as explained at the top of this document.
9569
9570 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9571 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9572 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009573 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9574 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9575 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9576 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009577 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9578 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9579 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009580 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009581 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009582 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9583 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009584 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9585 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009586
9587 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9588 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9589 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9590 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9591 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9592 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9593
9594 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9595 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9596 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9597
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009598 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9599 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009600
9601
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009602timeout client-fin <timeout>
9603 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9605 yes | yes | yes | no
9606 Arguments :
9607 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9608 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9609 as explained at the top of this document.
9610
9611 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9612 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9613 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9614 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9615 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9616 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9617 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9618 down in one direction.
9619
9620 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9621 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9622 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9623
9624 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9625
9626
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009627timeout connect <timeout>
9628timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9629 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9631 yes | no | yes | yes
9632 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009633 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009634 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9635 as explained at the top of this document.
9636
9637 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009638 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009639 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009640 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009641 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9642 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009643
9644 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9645 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9646 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9647 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9648 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9649 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9650
9651 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9652 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9653 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9654
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009655 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9656 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009657
9658
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009659timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9660 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9662 yes | yes | yes | yes
9663 Arguments :
9664 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9665 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9666 as explained at the top of this document.
9667
9668 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9669 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9670 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9671 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9672 once the request has started to present itself.
9673
9674 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9675 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9676 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9677 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9678 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9679
9680 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9681 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9682 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9683 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9684
9685 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9686 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9687 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9688 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9689 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009690 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009691
9692 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9693 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9694 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9695 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9696
9697 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9698
9699
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009700timeout http-request <timeout>
9701 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009704 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009705 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009706 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9707 as explained at the top of this document.
9708
9709 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9710 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9711 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9712 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9713 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9714 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9715 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009716 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9717 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9718 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9719 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9720 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009721 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9722 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009723
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009724 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9725 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9726 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9727 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9728 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009729 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009730
9731 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9732 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9733 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9734 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9735 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9736
9737 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009738 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9739 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9740 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009741
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009742 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009743 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009744
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009745
9746timeout queue <timeout>
9747 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9749 yes | no | yes | yes
9750 Arguments :
9751 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9752 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9753 as explained at the top of this document.
9754
9755 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9756 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9757 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9758 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9759 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9760
9761 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9762 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9763 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9764 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9765
9766 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9767
9768
9769timeout server <timeout>
9770timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9771 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9773 yes | no | yes | yes
9774 Arguments :
9775 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9776 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9777 as explained at the top of this document.
9778
9779 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9780 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9781 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9782 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9783 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9784 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9785 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9786
9787 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9788 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9789 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9790 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9791 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009792 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009793 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009794 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9795 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9796 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9797 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009798
9799 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9800 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9801 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9802 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9803 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9804 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9805
9806 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9807 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9808 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9809
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009810 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009811
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009812
9813timeout server-fin <timeout>
9814 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9816 yes | no | yes | yes
9817 Arguments :
9818 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9820 as explained at the top of this document.
9821
9822 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9823 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9824 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9825 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9826 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9827 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9828 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9829 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9830 situations, it should not be needed.
9831
9832 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9833 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9834 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9835
9836 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9837
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009838
9839timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009840 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9842 yes | yes | yes | yes
9843 Arguments :
9844 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9845 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9846 as explained at the top of this document.
9847
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009848 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9849 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9850 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9851 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009852
9853 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9854 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9855 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9856 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009857 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009858
9859 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9860
9861
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009862timeout tunnel <timeout>
9863 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9865 yes | no | yes | yes
9866 Arguments :
9867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9869 as explained at the top of this document.
9870
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009871 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009872 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9873 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9874 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9875 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9876 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9877 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9878 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9879 specified.
9880
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009881 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9882 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9883 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9884 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9885 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9886 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9887 state.
9888
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009889 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9890 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9891 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9892 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9893 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9894
9895 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9896 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9897 forget about it.
9898
9899 Example :
9900 defaults http
9901 option http-server-close
9902 timeout connect 5s
9903 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009904 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009905 timeout server 30s
9906 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9907
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009908 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009909
9910
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009911transparent (deprecated)
9912 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009914 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009915 Arguments : none
9916
9917 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9918 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9919 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9920 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9921 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9922 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9923 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9924 appropriate server.
9925
9926 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9927
9928 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9929 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9930
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009931 See also: "option transparent"
9932
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009933unique-id-format <string>
9934 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9936 yes | yes | yes | no
9937 Arguments :
9938 <string> is a log-format string.
9939
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009940 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9941 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9942 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9943 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009944
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009945 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9946 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9947 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9948 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9949 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9950 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9951 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9952 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009953
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009954 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9955 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009956
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009957 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009958
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009959 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009960
9961 will generate:
9962
9963 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9964
9965 See also: "unique-id-header"
9966
9967unique-id-header <name>
9968 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9970 yes | yes | yes | no
9971 Arguments :
9972 <name> is the name of the header.
9973
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009974 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9975 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009976
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009977 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009978
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009979 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009980 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9981
9982 will generate:
9983
9984 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9985
9986 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009987
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009988use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009989 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9991 no | yes | yes | no
9992 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009993 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9994 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009995
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009996 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9997 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009998
9999 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10000 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10001 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010002 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10003 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10004 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10005 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010006
10007 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10008 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10009 assign the backend.
10010
10011 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10012 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10013 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10014 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10015 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10016 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10017
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010018 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010019 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010020 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10021 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10022 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10023
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010024 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10025 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10026 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10027 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10028 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10029 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10030 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10031 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10032 cannot be forced from the request.
10033
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010034 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010035 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10036 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10037
10038 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10039 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010040
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010041
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010042use-server <server> if <condition>
10043use-server <server> unless <condition>
10044 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10046 no | no | yes | yes
10047 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010048 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010049
10050 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10051
10052 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10053 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10054 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10055
10056 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10057 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10058 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10059 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10060 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10061 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10062 matches will assign the server.
10063
10064 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10065 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10066 with the next rules until one matches.
10067
10068 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10069 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10070 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10071 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10072
10073 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10074 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10075 stripped.
10076
10077 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10078 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10079 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10080 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10081
10082 Example :
10083 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10084 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10085 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10086 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10087 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10088 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010089 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010090 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10091 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10092
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010093 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010095
100965. Bind and Server options
10097--------------------------
10098
10099The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10100depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10101settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10102written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10103described in this section.
10104
10105
101065.1. Bind options
10107-----------------
10108
10109The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10110as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10111no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10112parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10113while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10114provided immediately after the setting name.
10115
10116The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10117
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010118accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10119 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10120 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10121 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10122 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10123 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10124 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10125 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10126 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10127 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010128 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10129 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10130 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010132accept-proxy
10133 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010134 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10135 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010136 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10137 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10138 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10139 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10140 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10141 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10142 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010143 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10144 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010145
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010146alpn <protocols>
10147 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10148 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10149 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10150 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10151 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10152 initial NPN extension.
10153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010154backlog <backlog>
10155 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10156 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10157
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010158curves <curves>
10159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10160 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10161 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10162 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10163 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10164 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10165
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010166ecdhe <named curve>
10167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010168 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10169 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010170
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010171ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10173 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10174 client's certificate.
10175
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010176ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10177 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10178 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10179 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10180 error is ignored.
10181
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010182ca-sign-file <cafile>
10183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10184 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10185 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10186 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10187 'generate-certificates' for details.
10188
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010189ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010190 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10191 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10192 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10193 'generate-certificates' for details.
10194
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010195ciphers <ciphers>
10196 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10197 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010198 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010199 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10200 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10201
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010202crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10204 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10205 to verify client's certificate.
10206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010207crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010208 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10209 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10210 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10211 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10212 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10213 file.
10214
10215 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10216 are loaded.
10217
10218 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010219 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010220 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10221 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10222 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10223 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10224 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10225 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10226 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010227
10228 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10229 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10230 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10231 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010232 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10233 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010234
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010235 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010236
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010237 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10238 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010239 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010240 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10241 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10242 clients).
10243
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010244 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10245 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10246 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10247 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10248 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10249 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10250 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10251 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10252 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10253 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10254 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10255 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10256 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10257
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010258 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10259 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10260 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10261 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10262 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10263
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010264 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10265 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10266 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10267 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010268
10269 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10270 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10271 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10272 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10273 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10274 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10275 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10276 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10277 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10278
10279 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10280
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010281 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010282 a cert bundle.
10283
10284 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10285 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10286 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10287 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10288 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10289 provide multi-cert support.
10290
10291 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10292
10293 Filename | CN | SAN
10294 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10295 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010296 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010297 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10298 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10299
10300 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10301 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10302 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10303 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010304 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10305 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010306
10307 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10308 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10309
10310 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10311 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10312 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10313
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010314crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010315 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10316 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010317 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010318 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010319
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010320crt-list <file>
10321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010322 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10323 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010324
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010325 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10326
10327 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010328 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010329 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010330
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010331 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10332 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10333 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10334 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10335 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10336 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10337 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10338 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010339
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010340 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010341 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010342 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10343 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10344 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010345
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010346 crt-list file example:
10347 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010348 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010349 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010350 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010351
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010352defer-accept
10353 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10354 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10355 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10356 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10357 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10358 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10359 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10360 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10361 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10362 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10363 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10364
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010365force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010366 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010367 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010368 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10369 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010370
10371force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010372 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010373 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10374 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010375
10376force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010377 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010378 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10379 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010380
10381force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010382 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010383 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10384 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010385
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010386generate-certificates
10387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10388 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10389 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10390 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10391 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10392 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10393 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10394 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10395 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10396 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10397 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10398
10399 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10400 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10401 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10402 certificate is used many times.
10403
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010404gid <gid>
10405 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10406 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10407 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10408 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10409 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10410
10411group <group>
10412 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10413 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10414 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10415 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10416 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10417
10418id <id>
10419 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10420 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10421 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10422 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10423
10424interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010425 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10426 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10427 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10428 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10429 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10430 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10431 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010432
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010433level <level>
10434 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10435 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10436 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10437 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10438 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10439 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10440 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10441 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10442 counters).
10443 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10444 all counters).
10445
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010446maxconn <maxconn>
10447 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10448 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10449 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10450 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10451 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10452 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10453 eat all memory.
10454
10455mode <mode>
10456 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10457 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10458 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10459 UNIX sockets.
10460
10461mss <maxseg>
10462 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10463 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10464 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10465 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10466 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10467 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10468 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10469 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10470 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10471 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10472 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10473
10474name <name>
10475 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10476 page.
10477
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010478namespace <name>
10479 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10480 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10481 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10482 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10483
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010484nice <nice>
10485 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10486 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10487 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10488 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10489 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10490 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10491 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10492 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10493 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10494 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10495 one for an RDP socket.
10496
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010497no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010498 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010499 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010500 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010501 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10502 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010503 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010504
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010505no-tls-tickets
10506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10507 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10508 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010509 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10510 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010511
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010512no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010514 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010515 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010516 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10517 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10518 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010519
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010520no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010522 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010523 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010524 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10525 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10526 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010527
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010528no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010529 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010530 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010531 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010532 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10533 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10534 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010535
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010536npn <protocols>
10537 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10538 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10539 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10540 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010541 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10542 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010543
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010544process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10545 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10546 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10547 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10548 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10549 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10550 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10551 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010552 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10553 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10554 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10555 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10556 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10557 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10558 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010559
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010560ssl
10561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010562 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010563 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10564 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10565 to deciphered contents.
10566
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010567strict-sni
10568 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10569 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10570 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10571 See the "crt" option for more information.
10572
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010573tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010574 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010575 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10576 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010577 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010578 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10579 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10580 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10581 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10582 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10583 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10584 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10585
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010586tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010587 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010588 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10589 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10590 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10591 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10592 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10593 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10594 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010595 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10596 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10597 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010598
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010599tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10600 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10601 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10602 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10603 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10604 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10605 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10606 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10607 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10608 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10609 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10610
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010611transparent
10612 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10613 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10614 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10615 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10616 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10617 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10618 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10619 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10620 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10621 so check for support with your vendor.
10622
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010623v4v6
10624 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10625 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10626 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10627 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010628 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010629
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010630v6only
10631 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10632 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10633 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010634 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10635 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010636
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010637uid <uid>
10638 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10639 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10640 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10641 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10642 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10643
10644user <user>
10645 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10646 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10647 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10648 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10649 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10650
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010651verify [none|optional|required]
10652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10653 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10654 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10655 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10656 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010657 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10658 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10659 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10660 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010661
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106625.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010663------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010664
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010665The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10666which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10667arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10668settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10669after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10670Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10671address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010673 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010674 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010675
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010676Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10677keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010679The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010680
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010681addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010682 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010683 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10684 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10685 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10686 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10687 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010688
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010689agent-check
10690 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010691 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10692 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10693 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10694 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010695
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010696 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010697 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010698 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10699 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10700 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010701
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010702 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10703 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10704 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10705 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10706 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10707
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010708 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10709 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010710
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010711 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10712 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10713 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010714
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010715 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10716 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10717 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010718
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010719 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10720 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10721 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10722 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10723 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10724 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10725 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010726
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010727 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10728 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010729
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010730 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10731 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10732 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10733 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10734 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10735 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10736 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10737 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10738 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010739
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010740 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10741 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010742 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10743 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10744 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010745 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010746
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010747 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010748 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010749
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010750agent-send <string>
10751 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10752 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10753 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10754 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10755 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10756
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010757agent-inter <delay>
10758 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10759 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10760
10761 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10762 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10763 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10764 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10765 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10766 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10767 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10768 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10769 of backends use the same servers.
10770
10771 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10772
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010773agent-addr <addr>
10774 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10775
10776 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10777 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10778 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10779 hostname, it will be resolved.
10780
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010781agent-port <port>
10782 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10783
10784 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010786backup
10787 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10788 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10789 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10790 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010791 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10792 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010793
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010794ca-file <cafile>
10795 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10796 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10797 server's certificate.
10798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010799check
10800 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010801 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10802 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10803 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10804 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10805 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10806 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10807 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010808 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10809 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010810 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10811 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010812
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010813check-send-proxy
10814 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10815 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10816 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10817 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10818 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10819 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10820 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10821
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010822check-ssl
10823 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10824 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10825 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10826 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010827 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010828 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10829 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10830 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010831 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10832 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010833
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010834ciphers <ciphers>
10835 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010836 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010837 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10838 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10839 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10840 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10841 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10842 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010844cookie <value>
10845 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10846 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10847 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10848 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10849 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10850 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10851 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10852
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010853crl-file <crlfile>
10854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10855 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10856 to verify server's certificate.
10857
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010858crt <cert>
10859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10860 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10861 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10862 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10863 certificate request.
10864
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010865disabled
10866 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10867 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10868 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10869 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10870 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010871 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010872
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010873enabled
10874 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10875 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10876 default value.
10877 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10878 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010879
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010880error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010881 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10882 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10883 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010884
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010885 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010886
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010887fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010888 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10889 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10890 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10891
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010892force-sslv3
10893 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10894 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010895 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010896 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-sslv3", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010897
10898force-tlsv10
10899 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010900 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv10", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010902
10903force-tlsv11
10904 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010905 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010906 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv11", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010907
10908force-tlsv12
10909 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010910 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010911 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv12", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010913id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010914 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10915 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10916 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010917
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010918init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10919 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10920 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10921 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10922 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10923 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10924 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10925 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10926 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10927 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10928 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10929 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10930 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10931 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10932 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10933 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10934 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10935 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10936 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10937 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10938 historic behaviour.
10939
10940 Example:
10941 defaults
10942 # never fail on address resolution
10943 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010945inter <delay>
10946fastinter <delay>
10947downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010948 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10949 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10950 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10951 between checks depending on the server state :
10952
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010953 Server state | Interval used
10954 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10955 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10956 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10957 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10958 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10959 or yet unchecked. |
10960 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10961 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10962 | "inter" otherwise.
10963 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010965 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10966 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10967 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10968 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010969 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10970 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10971 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10972 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10973 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010975maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010976 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10977 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10978 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10979 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10980 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10981 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10982 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10983 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010985maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010986 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10987 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10988 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10989 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10990 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10991 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10992 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010994minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010995 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10996 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10997 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10998 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10999 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11000 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011001 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011002 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011003
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011004namespace <name>
11005 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11006 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11007 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11008 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11009
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011010no-agent-check
11011 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11012 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11013 default value.
11014 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11015 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11016
11017no-backup
11018 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11019 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11020 default value.
11021 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11022 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11023
11024no-check
11025 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11026 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11027 default value.
11028 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11029 "default-server" "check" setting.
11030
11031no-check-ssl
11032 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11033 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11034 default value.
11035 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11036 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11037
11038no-force-sslv3
11039 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-sslv3"
11040 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11041 default value.
11042 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11043 "default-server" "force-sslv3" setting.
11044
11045no-force-tlsv10
11046 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv10"
11047 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11048 default value.
11049 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11050 "default-server" "force-tlsv10" setting.
11051
11052no-force-tlsv11
11053 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv11"
11054 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11055 default value.
11056 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11057 "default-server" "force-tlsv11" setting.
11058
11059no-force-tlsv12
11060 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv12"
11061 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11062 default value.
11063 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11064 "default-server" "force-tlsv12" setting.
11065
11066no-send-proxy
11067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11069 default value.
11070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11071 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11072
11073no-send-proxy-v2
11074 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11075 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11076 default value.
11077 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11078 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11079
11080no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11081 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11082 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11083 default value.
11084 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11085 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11086
11087no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11088 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11089 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11090 default value.
11091 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11092 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11093
11094no-ssl
11095 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11096 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11097 default value.
11098 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11099 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11100
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011101no-ssl-reuse
11102 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11103 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11104 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11105 and for paranoid users.
11106
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011107no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011108 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11109 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011110 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011111
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011112no-tls-tickets
11113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11114 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11115 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011116 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11117 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011118 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011119
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011120no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011121 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011122 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11123 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011124 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11125 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011126 See also "tlsv10", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011127
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011128no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011129 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011130 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11131 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011132 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11133 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011134 See also "tlsv11", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011135
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011136no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011137 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011138 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11139 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011140 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11141 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011142 See also "tlsv12", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011143
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011144no-verifyhost
11145 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11146 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11147 default value.
11148 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11149 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011150
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011151non-stick
11152 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11153 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11154 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11155
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011156observe <mode>
11157 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11158 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11159 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11160 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11161 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11162 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011163 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011164
11165 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011167on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011168 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11169 Currently, four modes are available:
11170 - fastinter: force fastinter
11171 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11172 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11173 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11174 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11175
11176 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11177
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011178on-marked-down <action>
11179 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11180 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011181 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11182 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11183 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11184 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11185 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11186 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11187 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11188 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011189
11190 Actions are disabled by default
11191
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011192on-marked-up <action>
11193 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11194 Currently one action is available:
11195 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11196 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11197 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11198 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11199 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11200 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11201 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11202 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11203
11204 Actions are disabled by default
11205
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011206port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011207 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11208 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11209 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11210 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11211 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11212 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11213
11214redir <prefix>
11215 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11216 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11217 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11218 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11219 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11220 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11221 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11222 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011223 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011224 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11225 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11226 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11227 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11228 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11229
11230 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011232rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011233 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11234 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11235 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11236
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011237resolve-prefer <family>
11238 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11239 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11240 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11241 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11242
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011243 Default value: ipv6
11244
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011245 Example:
11246
11247 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011248
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011249resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11250 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11251 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011252 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011253 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11254 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11255 configured network, another address is selected.
11256
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011257 Example:
11258
11259 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011260
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011261resolvers <id>
11262 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11263 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011264 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11265 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11266 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11267 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011268
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011269 Example:
11270
11271 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011272
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011273 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011274
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011275send-proxy
11276 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11277 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11278 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11279 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011280 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11281 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11282 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11283 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11284 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11285 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11286 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11287 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11288 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11289 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011290 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11291 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011292
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011293send-proxy-v2
11294 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11295 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11296 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11297 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11298 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011299 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11300 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11301 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011302
11303send-proxy-v2-ssl
11304 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11305 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11306 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11307 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11308 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11309 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11310 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011311 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11312 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011313
11314send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11315 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11316 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11317 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11318 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11319 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11320 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11321 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11322 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011323 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11324 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011326slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011327 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11328 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11329 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11330 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11331 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11332 parameters :
11333
11334 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11335 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11336
11337 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11338 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11339 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11340 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11341
11342 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11343 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11344 seen as failed.
11345
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011346sni <expression>
11347 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11348 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11349 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11350 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11351 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11352
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011353source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011354source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011355source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011356 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11357 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11358 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11359 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11360
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011361 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11362 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11363 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11364 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11365 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11366 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11367 server.
11368
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011369 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11370 specifying the source address without port(s).
11371
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011372ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011373 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11374 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11375 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11376 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11377 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11378 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011379 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11380 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011381
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011382sslv3
11383 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-sslv3"
11384 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11385 default value.
11386 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11387 "default-server" "no-sslv3" setting.
11388
11389ssl-reuse
11390 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11391 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11392 default value.
11393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11394 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11395
11396stick
11397 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11398 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11399 default value.
11400 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11401 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011402
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011403tcp-ut <delay>
11404 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11405 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11406 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011407 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011408 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11409 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11410 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11411 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11412 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11413 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11414 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11415 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11416 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011418track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011419 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11420 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11421 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11422 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011423 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11424
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011425tlsv10
11426 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv10"
11427 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11428 default value.
11429 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11430 "default-server" "no-tlsv10" setting.
11431
11432tlsv11
11433 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv11"
11434 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11435 default value.
11436 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11437 "default-server" "no-tlsv11" setting.
11438
11439tlsv12
11440 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv12"
11441 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11442 default value.
11443 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11444 "default-server" "no-tlsv12" setting.
11445
11446tls-tickets
11447 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11448 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11449 default value.
11450 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11451 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011452
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011453verify [none|required]
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011455 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11456 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11457 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11458 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011459 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11460 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11461 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011462
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011463verifyhost <hostname>
11464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11465 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11466 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11467 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11468 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11469 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011470 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011472weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011473 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11474 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11475 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011476 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11477 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11478 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11479 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11480 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11481 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011482
11483
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114845.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11485-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011486
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011487HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11488using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11489configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011490This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11491can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11492workload.
11493This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11494resolution at run time.
11495Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11496carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11497
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011498Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11499health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11500
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011501
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115025.3.1. Global overview
11503----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011504
11505As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11506different steps of the process life:
11507
11508 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11509 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11510 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11511
11512 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11513 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11514 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11515
11516A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11517 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11518 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11519 resolution to know this new IP.
11520
11521A few things important to notice:
11522 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11523 first valid response.
11524
11525 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11526 servers return an error.
11527
11528
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115295.3.2. The resolvers section
11530----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011531
11532This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11533HAProxy.
11534There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11535many name servers.
11536
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011537When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11538uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11539is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11540answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11541
11542When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11543used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11544
11545Two types of behavior can be applied:
11546 1. stop DNS resolution
11547 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11548 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11549 1. ANY query type
11550 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11551 server's parameter
11552 3. remaining family type
11553
11554HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11555 - invalid DNS response packet
11556 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11557 - NX domain
11558 - Query refused by server
11559 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11560
11561HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11562 - no Answer records in the response
11563 - DNS response truncated
11564 - Error in DNS response
11565 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11566 - name server timeout
11567
11568For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11569 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11570 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11571 applied;
11572 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11573 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11574 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11575 stops resolution.
11576
11577
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011578resolvers <resolvers id>
11579 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11580
11581A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11582
11583nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11584 DNS server description:
11585 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11586 <ip> : IP address of the server
11587 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11588
11589hold <status> <period>
11590 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11591 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011592 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11593 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011594 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11595 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11596 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11597
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011598 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011599
11600 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11601 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11602 the healch check.
11603
11604resolve_retries <nb>
11605 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11606 giving up.
11607 Default value: 3
11608
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011609 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11610 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11611 type.
11612
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011613timeout <event> <time>
11614 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11615 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11616 events available are:
11617 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11618 been received.
11619 Default value: 1s
11620 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11621 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11622
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011623 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011624
11625 resolvers mydns
11626 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11627 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11628 resolve_retries 3
11629 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011630 hold other 30s
11631 hold refused 30s
11632 hold nx 30s
11633 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011634 hold valid 10s
11635
11636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116376. HTTP header manipulation
11638---------------------------
11639
11640In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11641response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11642request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11643which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011644against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011645
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011646If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11647to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11648but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11649HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11650stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11651because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11652a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11653still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011654
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011655This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11656in section 4.2 :
11657
11658 - reqadd <string>
11659 - reqallow <search>
11660 - reqiallow <search>
11661 - reqdel <search>
11662 - reqidel <search>
11663 - reqdeny <search>
11664 - reqideny <search>
11665 - reqpass <search>
11666 - reqipass <search>
11667 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11668 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11669 - reqtarpit <search>
11670 - reqitarpit <search>
11671 - rspadd <string>
11672 - rspdel <search>
11673 - rspidel <search>
11674 - rspdeny <search>
11675 - rspideny <search>
11676 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11677 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11678
11679With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11680is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11681parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11682prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11683Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11684
11685 \t for a tab
11686 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11687 \n for a new line (LF)
11688 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11689 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11690 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11691 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11692 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11693
11694The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11695portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11696above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11697regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
116989 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11699is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11700
11701The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11702after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11703
11704Notes related to these keywords :
11705---------------------------------
11706 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11707 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11708 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11709
11710 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11711 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11712 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11713
11714 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11715 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11716 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11717 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11718 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11719
11720 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11721 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11722 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11723 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11724 useless headers before adding new ones.
11725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011726 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011727 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11728
11729 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11730 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11731 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11732
11733 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11734 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011735 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011736
11737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117387. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11739----------------------------------
11740
11741Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11742client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11743The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11744these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11745but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11746data called patterns.
11747
11748
117497.1. ACL basics
11750---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011751
11752The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11753content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11754from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11755simple :
11756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011758 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011759 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11760 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011762The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11763adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011764
11765In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011767 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011768
11769This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11770Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11771and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011772an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11773conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11774as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11775are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011776
11777ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11778'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11779which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11780
11781There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11782performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011784The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11785specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11786this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011787methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11788ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011789
11790Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11791 - boolean
11792 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11793 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11794 - string
11795 - data block
11796
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011797Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11798converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11799would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11800The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11801which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11802
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011803Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11804keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11805fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11806which are summarized in the table below :
11807
11808 +---------------------+-----------------+
11809 | Sample or converter | Default |
11810 | output type | matching method |
11811 +---------------------+-----------------+
11812 | boolean | bool |
11813 +---------------------+-----------------+
11814 | integer | int |
11815 +---------------------+-----------------+
11816 | ip | ip |
11817 +---------------------+-----------------+
11818 | string | str |
11819 +---------------------+-----------------+
11820 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11821 +---------------------+-----------------+
11822
11823Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11824matching method, see below.
11825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011826The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11827 - boolean
11828 - integer or integer range
11829 - IP address / network
11830 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11831 - regular expression
11832 - hex block
11833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011834The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11835
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011836 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11837 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011839 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011840 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011841 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011842 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011844The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11845read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11846if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11847lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11848will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11849beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11850a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11851lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11852exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11853
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011854The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11855parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11856ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11857a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11858check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11859
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011860The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11861socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11862file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11865loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11866
11867 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11868
11869In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11870the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11871case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11872as well.
11873
11874The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11875sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11876do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11877methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11878is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11879obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11880followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11881default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11882that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11883string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11884
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011885The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11886By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11887string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11888resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11889server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11890waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11891flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11892function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011894There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11895sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11896be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011897
11898 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11899 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11901 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11902 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11903 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011904
11905 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11906 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011907 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011908
11909 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011911
11912 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011913 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011914
11915 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11916 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11917
11918 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11919 binary or string samples.
11920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11922 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11925 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11926 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11929 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11932 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011934 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11935 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011937 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11938 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011939 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011941 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11942 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11943 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011944
11945For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11946request, it is possible to do :
11947
11948 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11949
11950In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11951buffer, one would use the following acl :
11952
11953 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11954
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011955On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11956possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11957
11958 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11959
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011960All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11961criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11962method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11963to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11964criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11965the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011968the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11969For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011971 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11972 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11973 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11974 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011975
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011976
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011977The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11978types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11979combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11980brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11981default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 +-------------------------------------------------+
11984 | Input sample type |
11985 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011986 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11988 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11989 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011990 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011991 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011992 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011994 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011996 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011998 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012000 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012001 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012002 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012003 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012004 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012005 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012006 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012007 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012008 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012010 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012011 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12012 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12013 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012014
12015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120167.1.1. Matching booleans
12017------------------------
12018
12019In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12020Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12021When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12022that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12023
12024Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12025return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12026"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12027
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120297.1.2. Matching integers
12030------------------------
12031
12032Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12033enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12034to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12035
12036Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12037matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12038lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012039
12040For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12041unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12042representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12043
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012044As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12045two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12046instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12047ranges and operators.
12048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012049For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012050operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12051Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12052of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012054Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012055
12056 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12057 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12058 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12059 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12060 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12061
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012062For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012063
12064 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12065
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012066This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12067
12068 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12069
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120717.1.3. Matching strings
12072-----------------------
12073
12074String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12075different forms :
12076
12077 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12078 patterns ;
12079
12080 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12081 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12082
12083 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12084 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12085
12086 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12087 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12088
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012089 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012090 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12091 matches.
12092
12093 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12094 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12095 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012096
12097String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12098exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12099characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12100string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12101to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012102before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012103
12104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121057.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12106---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012107
12108Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12109they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12110possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12111passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12112the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012113the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12114match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012115
12116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121177.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12118-------------------------------------
12119
12120It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12121not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12122a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12123to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12124digits may be used upper or lower case.
12125
12126Example :
12127 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12128 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12129
12130
121317.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12132---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012133
12134IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12135netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12136within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012137host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012138difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12139at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12140does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12141parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012142
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012143The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12144abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12145
12146 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12147 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12148 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12149 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12150 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12151 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12152 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12153 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12154
12155Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12156192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12157
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012158IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12159Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12160trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12161IPv6 patterns.
12162
12163HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12164following situations :
12165 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12166 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12167 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12168 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12169 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12170 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12171 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12172 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12173 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12174 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012176
121777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12178----------------------------------
12179
12180Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12181combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12182
12183 - AND (implicit)
12184 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12185 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012187A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012189 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012191Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12192indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012194For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12195"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12196requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12197is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12198
12199 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012200 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12201 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12202 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012203
12204To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12205and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12206
12207 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12208 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12209 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12210 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12211
12212 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12213 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12214 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12215 use_backend www if host_www
12216
12217It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12218expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12219be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12220the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12221
12222 The following rule :
12223
12224 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012225 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012226
12227 Can also be written that way :
12228
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012229 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012230
12231It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12232to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12233simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12234sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12235good use is the following :
12236
12237 With named ACLs :
12238
12239 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12240 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12241 monitor fail if site_dead
12242
12243 With anonymous ACLs :
12244
12245 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12246
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012247See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12248keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012249
12250
122517.3. Fetching samples
12252---------------------
12253
12254Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12255against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12256sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12257ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12258of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12259available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12260
12261This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12262Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12263compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12264deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12265
12266The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12267matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12268method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12269indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12270
12271As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12272when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12273mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12274the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12275ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12276
12277Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12278multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12279when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12280incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12281are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12282is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12283all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12284
12285Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12286 - name
12287 - name(arg1)
12288 - name(arg1,arg2)
12289
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012290
122917.3.1. Converters
12292-----------------
12293
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012294Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12295of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12296is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12297was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12298has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12299unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12300
12301These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12302sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12303the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12304support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012305
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012306A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12307support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12308supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12309(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12310bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012312The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012313
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001231451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12315 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12316 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12317 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12318 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12319 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12320
12321 Example :
12322 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12323 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12324 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12325 frontend http-in
12326 bind *:8081
12327 default_backend servers
12328 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12329 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12330
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012331add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012332 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012333 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012334 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12335 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012336 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012337 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12338 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12341 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012342 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012343
12344and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012345 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012346 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012347 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12348 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012349 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012350 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12351 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12352 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12353 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12354 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012355 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012356
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012357base64
12358 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12359 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12360 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012362bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012363 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012364 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12365 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12366 presence of a flag).
12367
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012368bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12369 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12370 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012371 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012372
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012373cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012374 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12375 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012376
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012377crc32([<avalanche>])
12378 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12379 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12380 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12381 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12382 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12383 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12384 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12385 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12386 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12387 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12388 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12389
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012390da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012391 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12392 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12393 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12394 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012395 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012396 configuration language.
12397
12398 Example:
12399 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012400 bind *:8881
12401 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012402 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012403
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012404debug
12405 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12406 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12407 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12408
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012409div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012410 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12411 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012412 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012413 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12414 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012415 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012416 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12417 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12418 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12419 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12420 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012421 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012422
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012423djb2([<avalanche>])
12424 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12425 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12426 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12427 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12428 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12429 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12430 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012431 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12432 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012433
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012434even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012435 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012436 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12437
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012438field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12439 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12440 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12441 list of chars.
12442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012443hex
12444 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12445 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12446 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12447 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012448
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012449http_date([<offset>])
12450 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12451 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12452 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12453 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12454 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12455 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012456
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012457in_table(<table>)
12458 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12459 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12460 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12461 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12462 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12463
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012464ipmask(<mask>)
12465 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12466 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12467 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12468 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12469
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012470json([<input-code>])
12471 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12472 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012473 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012474 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12475 of errors:
12476 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12477 bytes, ...)
12478 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12479 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12480
12481 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12482 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12483 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12484 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12485 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12486 are :
12487 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12488 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12489 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12490 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12491 error ;
12492 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12493 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12494
12495 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12496 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12497
12498 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012499 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012500 capture request header user-agent len 150
12501 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012502
12503 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12504 GET / HTTP/1.0
12505 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12506
12507 Output log:
12508 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12509
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012510language(<value>[,<default>])
12511 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12512 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12513 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12514 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12515 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12516 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12517 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12518 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12519 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12520 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12521 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12522 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012523
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012524 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012526 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12527 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012528
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012529 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12530 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12531 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12532 use_backend spanish if es
12533 use_backend french if fr
12534 use_backend english if en
12535 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012536
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012537lower
12538 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12539 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12540 type. The result is of type string.
12541
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012542ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12543 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12544 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12545 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12546 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12547 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12548 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12549
12550 Example :
12551
12552 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12553 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12554 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12555
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012556map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12557map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12558map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12559 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12560 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12561 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12562 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12563 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12564 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12565 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12566 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012567
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012568 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12569 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12570 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012571
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012572 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012573 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012575 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12577 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012579 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12580 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012581 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12582 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12583 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12584 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12585 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12586 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12587 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12588 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012589 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12590 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12591 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012592 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12593 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12594 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12595 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12596 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012597
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012598 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12599 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12600 the corresponding match text.
12601
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012602 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12603 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12604 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12605 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12606 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012607
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012608 Example :
12609
12610 # this is a comment and is ignored
12611 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12612 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12613 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12614 | | | `---------- value
12615 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12616 | `---------------------------- key
12617 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12618
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012619mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012620 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12621 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012622 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012623 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012624 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012625 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12626 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12627 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12628 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12629 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012630 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012631
12632mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012633 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012634 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12635 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012636 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012644 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012645
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012646nbsrv
12647 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12648 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12649 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12650 map lookup.
12651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012652neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012653 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12654 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12655 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12656 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012657
12658not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012659 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012660 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12661 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12662 absence of a flag).
12663
12664odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012665 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012666 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12667
12668or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012669 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012670 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012671 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12672 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012673 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012674 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12675 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12676 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12677 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12678 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012679 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012680
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012681regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012682 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12683 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12684 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12685 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12686 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12687 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12688 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12689 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12690 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12691 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012692 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12693 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12694 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12695 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012696
12697 Example :
12698
12699 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12700 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12701 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12702 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12703
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012704capture-req(<id>)
12705 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12706 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12707
12708 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012709 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12710 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012711
12712capture-res(<id>)
12713 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12714 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12715
12716 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012717 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12718 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012719
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012720sdbm([<avalanche>])
12721 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12722 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12723 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12724 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12725 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12726 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12727 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012728 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12729 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012730
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012731set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012732 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12733 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12734 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012735 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012736 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12737 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012738 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012739 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12740 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012741 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012742 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012743
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012744sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012745 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12746 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012747 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012748 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12749 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012750 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012751 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12752 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012753 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012754 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12755 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012757 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012758
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012759table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12760 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12761 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12762 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12763 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12764 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12765 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12766
12767
12768table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12769 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12770 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12771 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12772 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12773 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12774 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12775
12776table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12777 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12778 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12779 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12780 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12781 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12782
12783table_conn_cur(<table>)
12784 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12785 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12786 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12787 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12788 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12789
12790table_conn_rate(<table>)
12791 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12792 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12793 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12794 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12795 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012797table_gpt0(<table>)
12798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12800 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12801 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12802 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12803
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012804table_gpc0(<table>)
12805 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12806 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12807 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12808 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12809 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12810
12811table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12812 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12813 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12814 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12815 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12816 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12817 sample fetch keyword.
12818
12819table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12823 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12824 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12825
12826table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12829 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12830 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12831 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12832 keyword.
12833
12834table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12838 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12839 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12840
12841table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12844 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12845 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12846 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12847 keyword.
12848
12849table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12850 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12851 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12852 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12853 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12854 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12855 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12856 keyword.
12857
12858table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12862 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12863 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12864 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12865 keyword.
12866
12867table_server_id(<table>)
12868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12871 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12872 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12873 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12874
12875table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12878 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12879 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12880 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12881 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12882 keyword.
12883
12884table_sess_rate(<table>)
12885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12887 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12888 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12889 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12890 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12891 keyword.
12892
12893table_trackers(<table>)
12894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12897 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12898 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12899 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12900 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12901 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12902 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12903 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12904
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012905upper
12906 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12907 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12908 type. The result is of type string.
12909
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012910url_dec
12911 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12912 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12913
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012914unset-var(<var name>)
12915 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12916 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12917 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12918 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12919 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12920 response),
12921 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12922 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12923 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12924 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12925
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012926utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12927 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12928 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12929 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12930 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12931 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12932 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12933
12934 Example :
12935
12936 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12937 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12938 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12939
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012940word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12941 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12942 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12943
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012944wt6([<avalanche>])
12945 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12946 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12947 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12948 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12949 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12950 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12951 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012952 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12953 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012954
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012955xor(<value>)
12956 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012957 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012958 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012959 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012960 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012961 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12962 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012963 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012968
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012969xxh32([<seed>])
12970 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12971 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12972 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12973 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12974 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12975 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12976 as cryptographically secure.
12977
12978xxh64([<seed>])
12979 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12980 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12981 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12982 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12983 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12984 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12985 as cryptographically secure.
12986
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012987
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989--------------------------------------------
12990
12991A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12992not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12993"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12994The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12995
12996always_false : boolean
12997 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12998 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12999
13000always_true : boolean
13001 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13002 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13003
13004avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013005 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013006 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13007 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13008 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13009 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13010 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13011 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13012 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13013 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13014 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13015 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13016 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13017 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13018 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013020be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013021 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13022 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13023 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13024 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13025 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13028 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13029 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13030 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13031 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13032 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13033 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013034
13035 Example :
13036 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13037 backend dynamic
13038 mode http
13039 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13040 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013041
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013042bin(<hexa>) : bin
13043 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13044 of the string.
13045
13046bool(<bool>) : bool
13047 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13048 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013050connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13051 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013052 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013053 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13054 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013055
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013056 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013057 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013058 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13059
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013060 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13061 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013062
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013063 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013064 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013065 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013066 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13067 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013069 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013070
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013071 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13072 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013074 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013075
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013076date([<offset>]) : integer
13077 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13078 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13079 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13080 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013081 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13082
13083 Example :
13084
13085 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13086 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013087
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013088env(<name>) : string
13089 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13090 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13091 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13092 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13093 certain way.
13094
13095 Examples :
13096 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13097 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13098
13099 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13100 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13103 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013104 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13105 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13107 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13108 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13109 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13110 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013111
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013112fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13113 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13114 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13115 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13118 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13119 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13120 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13121 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13122 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13123 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13124 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13125 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013126
13127 Example :
13128 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13129 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13130 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13131 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13132 frontend mail
13133 bind :25
13134 mode tcp
13135 maxconn 100
13136 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13137 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13138 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13139 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013140
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013141hostname : string
13142 Returns the system hostname.
13143
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013144int(<integer>) : signed integer
13145 Returns a signed integer.
13146
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013147ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13148 Returns an ipv4.
13149
13150ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13151 Returns an ipv6.
13152
13153meth(<method>) : method
13154 Returns a method.
13155
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013156nbproc : integer
13157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13158 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13159 and debugging purposes.
13160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13162 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13163 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13164 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013165 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13166 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13167 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013168
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013169proc : integer
13170 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13171 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13172 debugging purposes.
13173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013175 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13176 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13177 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013178 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13179 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13180 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13181 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13182 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13183
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013184rand([<range>]) : integer
13185 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13186 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13187 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13188 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13189 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013191srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13192 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13193 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13194 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13195 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13196 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13197 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13198 methods.
13199
13200srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13201 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13202 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13203 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13204 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13205 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13206 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13207 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13208
13209srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13210 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13211 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013212 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13214 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13215 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13216 overloading servers).
13217
13218 Example :
13219 # Redirect to a separate back
13220 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13221 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13222 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13223
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013224stopping : boolean
13225 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13226 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13227 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13228
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013229str(<string>) : string
13230 Returns a string.
13231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13233 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13234 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13235
13236table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13237 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13238 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13239 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13240
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013241var(<var-name>) : undefined
13242 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013243 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13244 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013245 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013246 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13247 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013248 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013249 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13250 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013251 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013252 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013253
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132547.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255----------------------------------
13256
13257The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13258closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13259methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13260sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13261TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013262the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13263counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13264"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013265argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13266the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13267this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268
13269be_id : integer
13270 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13271 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13272
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013273be_name : string
13274 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13275 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013277dst : ip
13278 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13279 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13280 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13281 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13282 RFC 4291.
13283
13284dst_conn : integer
13285 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13286 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13287 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13288 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13289 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13290 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13291 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13292 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013293
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013294dst_is_local : boolean
13295 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13296 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13297 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13298 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13299 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13300 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13301 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13302 it only once per connection.
13303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013304dst_port : integer
13305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13306 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13307 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13308 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13309 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13310 an HTTP header.
13311
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013312fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13313 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13314 header.
13315
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013316fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13317 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13318 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13319 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13320 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13321 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13322 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13323
13324fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13325 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13326 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13327 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13328 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13329 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13330 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13331
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013332fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13333 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13334 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13335 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13336 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13337
13338fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13339 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13340 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13341 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13342 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13343
13344fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13345 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13346 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13347 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13348 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13349
13350fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13351 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13352 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13353 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13354 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13355
13356fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13357 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13358 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13359 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13360 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13361
13362fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13363 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13364 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13365 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13366 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013368fe_id : integer
13369 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013370 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013371 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13372
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013373fe_name : string
13374 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13375 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13376 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013378sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013379sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13380sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13381sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013382 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13383 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13384 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13385
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013386sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013387sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13388sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13389sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013390 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13391 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13392 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13393
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013394sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013395sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13396sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13397sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013398 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13399 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013400 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13401 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13402 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013403
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013404 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013405 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13406 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013407 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13408 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13409 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013410 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13411 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13412
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013413sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013414sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13415sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13416sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013417 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13418 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13419
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013420sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013421sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13422sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13423sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013424 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13425 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13426 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13427
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013428sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013429sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13430sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13431sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013432 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13433 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13434 See also src_conn_rate.
13435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013436sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013437sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13438sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13439sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013440 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013441 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013442
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013443sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13444sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13445sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13446sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13447 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13448 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13449
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013450sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013451sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13452sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13453sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013454 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13455 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13456 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013457 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13458 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13459 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013460
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013461sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013462sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13463sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13464sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013465 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13466 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13467 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13468
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013469sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013470sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13471sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13472sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013473 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13474 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13475 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13476 src_http_err_rate.
13477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013478sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013479sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13480sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13481sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013482 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13483 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13484 src_http_req_cnt.
13485
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013486sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013487sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13488sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13489sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013490 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13491 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13492 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13493 src_http_req_rate.
13494
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013495sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013496sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13497sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13498sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013499 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013500 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13501 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13502 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13503 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013504
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013505 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013506 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13507 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013508 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13509
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013510sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013511sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13512sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13513sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013514 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13515 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13516 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013518sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013519sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13520sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13521sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013522 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13523 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13524 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013526sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013527sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13528sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13529sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013530 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13531 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13532 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13533 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013534 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013535 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013537sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013538sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13539sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13540sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013541 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13542 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13543 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13544 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13545 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013546 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013547
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013548sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013549sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13550sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13551sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013552 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13553 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13554 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13555
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013556sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013557sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13558sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13559sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013560 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13561 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013562 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013563 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13564 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013565 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13566 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13567 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569so_id : integer
13570 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13571 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13572 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013574src : ip
13575 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13576 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13577 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13578 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013579 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13580 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13581 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13582 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013583
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013584 Example:
13585 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13586 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013588src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13589 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13590 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13591 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013592 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013594src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13595 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13596 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013597 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013598 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013600src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13601 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13602 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13603 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13604 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13605 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13606 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013607
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013608 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013609 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13610 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13611 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13612 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013613 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013614 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13615 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013617src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013618 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013620 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013621 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013624 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13626 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013627 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013629src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13630 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13631 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13632 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013633 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013635src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013636 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013637 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013638 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013639 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013640
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013641src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13642 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13643 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13644 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13645 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013648 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013650 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13651 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013652 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13653 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13654 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013656src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13657 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13658 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013659 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013660 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013663src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13664 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13665 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13666 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13667 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013668 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13671 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13672 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13673 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013674 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13677 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13678 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13679 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013680 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013681 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13684 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13685 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13686 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013687 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013688 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13689 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013690
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013691 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013692 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013693 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013694 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013695
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013696src_is_local : boolean
13697 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13698 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13699 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13700 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13701 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13702 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13703 once per connection.
13704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013706 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13707 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13708 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13709 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13710 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013713 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13714 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13715 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13716 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13717 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719src_port : integer
13720 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13721 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13722 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13723 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13726 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013727 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13728 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13729 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013730 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13733 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13734 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13735 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13736 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013737 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13740 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13741 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13742 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13743 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13744 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13745 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13746 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13747 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013748
13749 Example :
13750 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13751 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13752 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13753 listen ssh
13754 bind :22
13755 mode tcp
13756 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013757 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013759 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013761srv_id : integer
13762 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13763 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13764 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013765
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137667.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013769The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13770closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13771when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13772usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013773future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013774
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001377551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13776 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13777 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13778 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13779 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13780 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13781
13782 Example :
13783 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13784 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13785 # the request.
13786 frontend http-in
13787 bind *:8081
13788 default_backend servers
13789 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13790 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13791
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013792ssl_bc : boolean
13793 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13794 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13795 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13796
13797ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13798 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13799 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13800
13801ssl_bc_cipher : string
13802 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13803 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13804
13805ssl_bc_protocol : string
13806 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13807 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13808
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013809ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013810 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013811 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13812 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013813
13814ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13815 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13816 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13817 if session was reused or not.
13818
13819ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13820 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13821 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013823ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13824 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13825 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13826 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13827 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13828 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13832 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13833 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13834 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013835
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013836ssl_c_der : binary
13837 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13838 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13839 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013841ssl_c_err : integer
13842 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13843 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13844 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13845 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13846 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013848ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13849 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13850 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13851 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13852 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13853 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13854 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13855 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13856 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858ssl_c_key_alg : string
13859 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13860 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13861 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863ssl_c_notafter : string
13864 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13865 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13866 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013868ssl_c_notbefore : string
13869 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13870 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13871 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13874 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13875 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13876 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13877 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13878 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13879 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13880 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13881 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013883ssl_c_serial : binary
13884 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13885 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13886 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13889 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13890 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13891 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013892 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13893 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13894
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013895 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013896 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013898ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13899 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13900 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13901 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903ssl_c_used : boolean
13904 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13905 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013907ssl_c_verify : integer
13908 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13909 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13910 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13911 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013913ssl_c_version : integer
13914 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13915 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013916
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013917ssl_f_der : binary
13918 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13919 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13920 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013922ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13923 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13924 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13925 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13926 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013927 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013928 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13929 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13930 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013932ssl_f_key_alg : string
13933 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13934 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13935 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937ssl_f_notafter : string
13938 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13939 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13940 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942ssl_f_notbefore : string
13943 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13944 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13945 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13948 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13949 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13950 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13951 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13952 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13953 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13954 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13955 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013957ssl_f_serial : binary
13958 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13959 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13960 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013961
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013962ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13963 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13964 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13965 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013967ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13968 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13969 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13970 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013972ssl_f_version : integer
13973 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13974 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13975
13976ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013977 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13978 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13979 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013981 Example :
13982 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13983 listen http-https
13984 bind :80
13985 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13986 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13987
13988ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13989 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13990 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13991
13992ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013993 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13995 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13996 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13997 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13998 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13999 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14000 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14001 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014003ssl_fc_cipher : string
14004 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14005 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014006
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014007ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14008 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14009 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014010 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014011
14012ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14013 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14014 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014015 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014016
14017ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14018 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14019 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14020 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14021 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14022 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14023 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14024
14025ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14026 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14027 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014028 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014031 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14032 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014033 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14034 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14035 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14036 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14039 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014040 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14041 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14042 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14043 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014044
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014045ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014046 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14047 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014049ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014050 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14052 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14053 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14054 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14055 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14056 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14057 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059ssl_fc_protocol : string
14060 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14061 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014062
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014063ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014064 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014065 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14066 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14069 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14070 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14071 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14072 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074ssl_fc_sni : string
14075 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14076 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14077 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14078 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14079 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14080
14081 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14082 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14083 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014084 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14085 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14089 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014091ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14092 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14093 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014094
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014095
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140967.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014097------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014099Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14100sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14101only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14102For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14103be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14104can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14105sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14106for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14107content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14110 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14111 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14112 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14115 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14116 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14117 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119req.len : integer
14120req_len : integer (deprecated)
14121 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14122 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14123 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14124 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14125 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14126 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14127 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14128 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014130req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14131 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014132 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14133 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14134 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14135 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137 ACL alternatives :
14138 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014140req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14141 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14142 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14143 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14144 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146 ACL alternatives :
14147 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014151req.proto_http : boolean
14152req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14153 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14154 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14155 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14156 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14157 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14158 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14159 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161 Example:
14162 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14163 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14164 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014165 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14168rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14169 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14170 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14171 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14172 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14173 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14174 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14175 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014177 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14178 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14179 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14180 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14181 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14182 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184 ACL derivatives :
14185 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187 Example :
14188 listen tse-farm
14189 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14190 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14191 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14192 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14193 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14194 persist rdp-cookie
14195 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14196 # This is only useful makes sense if
14197 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14198 stick-table type string size 204800
14199 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14200 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14201 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014203 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14204 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014206req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14207rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14208 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14209 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14210 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14211 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014213 ACL derivatives :
14214 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014215
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014216req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14217 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14218 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014219 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14220 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14221 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14222 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14223 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14226req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14227 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14228 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14229 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14230 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14231 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14232 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14233 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235req.ssl_sni : string
14236req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14237 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14238 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14239 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14240 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14241 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14242 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14243 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14244 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14245 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14246 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14247 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14248 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250 ACL derivatives :
14251 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253 Examples :
14254 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14255 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14256 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14257 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14258 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014259
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014260req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14261 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14262 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14263 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14264 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14265 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14266 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14267 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14268 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14269 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014271req.ssl_ver : integer
14272req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14273 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14274 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14275 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14276 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14277 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14278 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14279 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14280 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14281 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283 ACL derivatives :
14284 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014285
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014286res.len : integer
14287 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14288 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14289 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14290 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14291 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14292 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14293 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14294 content inspection.
14295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014296res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14297 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014298 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14299 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14300 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14301 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014303res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14304 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14305 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14306 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14307 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014310
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014311res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14312rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14313 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14314 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14315 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14316 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14317 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14318 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14319 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321wait_end : boolean
14322 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14323 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14324 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14325 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14326 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14327 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14328 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14329 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331 Examples :
14332 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14333 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14334 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014336 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14337 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14338 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14339 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14340 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14341 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14342 tcp-request content reject
14343
14344
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346--------------------------------------
14347
14348It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14349This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14350data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14351its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14352HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14353content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14354to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14355more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14356response are indexed.
14357
14358base : string
14359 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14360 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14361 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14362 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14363 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14364 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14365 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14366 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14367
14368 ACL derivatives :
14369 base : exact string match
14370 base_beg : prefix match
14371 base_dir : subdir match
14372 base_dom : domain match
14373 base_end : suffix match
14374 base_len : length match
14375 base_reg : regex match
14376 base_sub : substring match
14377
14378base32 : integer
14379 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14380 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14381 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014382 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14383 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14384 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385
14386base32+src : binary
14387 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14388 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14389 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14390 per-URL counters.
14391
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014392capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14393 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14394 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14395 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14396
14397capture.req.method : string
14398 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14399 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14400 because it's allocated.
14401
14402capture.req.uri : string
14403 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14404 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14405 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14406 allocated.
14407
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014408capture.req.ver : string
14409 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14410 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14411 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14412
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014413capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14414 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14415 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14416 The first entry is an index of 0.
14417 See also: "capture response header"
14418
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014419capture.res.ver : string
14420 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14421 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14422 persistent flag.
14423
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014424req.body : binary
14425 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14426 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14427 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14428 the first chunk is analyzed.
14429
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014430req.body_param([<name>) : string
14431 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14432 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14433 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14434 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14435 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14436 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14437 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14438 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14439 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14440 given.
14441
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014442req.body_len : integer
14443 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14444 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14445 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14446 "option http-buffer-request".
14447
14448req.body_size : integer
14449 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14450 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14451 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14452 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14453 "option http-buffer-request".
14454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455req.cook([<name>]) : string
14456cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14457 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14458 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14459 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14460 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14461 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14462 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14463 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14464 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14465
14466 ACL derivatives :
14467 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14468 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14469 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14470 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14471 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14472 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14473 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14474 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14477cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14478 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14479 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014481req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14482cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14483 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14484 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14485 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14486 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14489 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14490 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14491 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14492 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014493 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14495 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14496 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14497 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14500 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14501 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14502 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14503 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014504 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14507 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14508 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14509 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14510 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14511 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14512 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14513 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14514 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014516req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14517 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14518 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14519 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14520 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14523 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14524 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14525 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14526 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14527 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14528 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14529 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14530 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14531 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14532 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14533 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014535 ACL derivatives :
14536 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14537 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14538 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14539 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14540 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14541 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14542 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14543 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14544
14545req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14546hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14547 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14548 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14549 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14550 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14551 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14552 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14553 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14554 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14555 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14556
14557req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14558hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14559 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14560 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14561 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14562 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14563 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14564 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14565 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14566 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14567
14568req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14569hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14570 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14571 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14572 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14573 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14574 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14575 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14576 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14577
14578http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14579 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14580 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14581 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14582 basic auth is supported.
14583
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014584http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14585 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14586 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14587 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14588 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14590 basic auth is supported.
14591
14592 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014593 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14594 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14595 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14596 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014597
14598http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014599 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14600 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14602 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014604method : integer + string
14605 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14606 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14607 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14608 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14609 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14610 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14611 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613 ACL derivatives :
14614 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014616 Example :
14617 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14618 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14619 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621path : string
14622 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14623 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14624 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14625 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14626 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14627 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14628 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630 ACL derivatives :
14631 path : exact string match
14632 path_beg : prefix match
14633 path_dir : subdir match
14634 path_dom : domain match
14635 path_end : suffix match
14636 path_len : length match
14637 path_reg : regex match
14638 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014639
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014640query : string
14641 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14642 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14643 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14644 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014645 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014646 which stops before the question mark.
14647
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014648req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14649 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14650 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14651 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14652 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014654req.ver : string
14655req_ver : string (deprecated)
14656 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14657 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14658 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660 ACL derivatives :
14661 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014663res.comp : boolean
14664 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14665 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14666 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668res.comp_algo : string
14669 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14670 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14671 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014673res.cook([<name>]) : string
14674scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14675 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14676 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14677 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014679 ACL derivatives :
14680 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014682res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14683scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14684 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14685 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14686 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014688res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14689scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14690 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14691 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14692 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14695 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14696 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14697 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14698 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14699 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14700 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14701 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14702 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14703 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14706 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14707 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14708 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14709 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14710 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14713shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14714 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14715 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14716 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14717 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14718 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14719 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14720 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14721 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014723 ACL derivatives :
14724 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14725 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14726 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14727 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14728 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14729 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14730 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14731 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14732
14733res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14734shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14735 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14736 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14737 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14738 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14739 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14742shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14743 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14744 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14745 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14746 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14747 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14748 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014749
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014750res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14751 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14752 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14753 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14754 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14757shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14758 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14759 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14760 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14761 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14762 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14763 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765res.ver : string
14766resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14767 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14768 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770 ACL derivatives :
14771 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014772
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014773set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14774 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14775 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014776 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014777 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14780 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782status : integer
14783 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14784 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14785 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014786
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014787unique-id : string
14788 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14789 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14790 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14791 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14792 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14793 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014795url : string
14796 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14797 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14798 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14799 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14800 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14801 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14802 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 ACL derivatives :
14805 url : exact string match
14806 url_beg : prefix match
14807 url_dir : subdir match
14808 url_dom : domain match
14809 url_end : suffix match
14810 url_len : length match
14811 url_reg : regex match
14812 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814url_ip : ip
14815 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14816 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14817 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14818 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14819 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14820 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14821 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014823url_port : integer
14824 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14825 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14826 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14827 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014828
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014829urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14830url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14832 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014833 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14834 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14835 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14836 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14838 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014839 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14840 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842 ACL derivatives :
14843 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14844 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14845 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14846 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14847 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14848 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14849 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14850 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014851
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853 Example :
14854 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14855 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14856 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14857 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014858
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014859urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014860 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14861 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14862 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014863
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014864url32 : integer
14865 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14866 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14867 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14868 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14869 is an unsigned integer.
14870
14871url32+src : binary
14872 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14873 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14874 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14875
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014878---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014880Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14881every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014882order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014884ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14885---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014886FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014887HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014888HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14889HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014890HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14891HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14892HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14893HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14894LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014895METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014896METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014897METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14898METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14899METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14900METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014901METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014902METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014903RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014904REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014905TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014906WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14907---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014908
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149108. Logging
14911----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014912
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014913One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14914provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14915very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14916provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14917state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014918to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014919headers.
14920
14921In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14922about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14923send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14924
14925 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14926 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14927 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14928 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14929 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014930 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14931 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014932
14933The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14934allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14935as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14936while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14937real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14938delay.
14939
14940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149418.1. Log levels
14942---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014943
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014944TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014945source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014946HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14947in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14948track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14949syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14950about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014951
14952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149538.2. Log formats
14954----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014955
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014956HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014957and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14958slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14959options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014960
14961 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14962 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14963 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14964 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14965 extents.
14966
14967 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14968 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14969 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14970 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14971 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14972
14973 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14974 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14975 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14976 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14977 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14978
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014979 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14980 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14981 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14982 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14983
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014984 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014986Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14987specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14988field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14989servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14990always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14991identifier.
14992
14993Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14994 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14995 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14996 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14997 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14998
14999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150008.2.1. Default log format
15001-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015002
15003This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15004as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15005format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15006
15007 Example :
15008 listen www
15009 mode http
15010 log global
15011 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15012
15013 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15014 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15015 (www/HTTP)
15016
15017 Field Format Extract from the example above
15018 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15019 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15020 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15021 4 'to' to
15022 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15023 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15024
15025Detailed fields description :
15026 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15027 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15028 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15029 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15030 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15031 and processed the connection.
15032 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15033
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015034In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15035"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15036connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015038It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15039will eventually disappear.
15040
15041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150428.2.2. TCP log format
15043---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015044
15045The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15046is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15047information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15048counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15049emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15050environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15051the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15052sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015053specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15054not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15055fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15056marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015057
15058 Example :
15059 frontend fnt
15060 mode tcp
15061 option tcplog
15062 log global
15063 default_backend bck
15064
15065 backend bck
15066 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15067
15068 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15069 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15070 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15071
15072 Field Format Extract from the example above
15073 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15074 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15075 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15076 4 frontend_name fnt
15077 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15078 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15079 7 bytes_read* 212
15080 8 termination_state --
15081 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15082 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15083
15084Detailed fields description :
15085 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015086 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15087 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15088 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015089 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15090 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15091 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015092
15093 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015094 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15095 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15096 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015097
15098 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15099 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15100 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15101 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15102
15103 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15104 and processed the connection.
15105
15106 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15107 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15108 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15109 applications.
15110
15111 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15112 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15113 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15114 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15115 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15116
15117 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15118 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15119 See "Timers" below for more details.
15120
15121 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15122 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15123 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15124 "Timers" below for more details.
15125
15126 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015127 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015128 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15129 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15130 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15131 details.
15132
15133 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15134 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15135 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15136 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15137 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15138
15139 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15140 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15141 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15142 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15143 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15144 for more details.
15145
15146 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015147 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015148 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15149 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15150 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015151 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015152
15153 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15154 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15155 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15156 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15157 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15158 caused by a denial of service attack.
15159
15160 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15161 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15162 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15163 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15164 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15165 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15166 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15167 denial of service attack.
15168
15169 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15170 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15171 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15172 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15173 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15174 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15175 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15176 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15177 be processed than on other servers.
15178
15179 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15180 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15181 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15182 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15183 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15184 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15185 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15186 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15187 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15188 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15189 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15190 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15191 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15192
15193 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15194 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15195 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15196 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15197 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15198 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15199 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15200 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15201
15202 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15203 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15204 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15205 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15206 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15207 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15208 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15209 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15210 occurs.
15211
15212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152138.2.3. HTTP log format
15214----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015215
15216The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15217is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15218the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15219are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15220emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15221generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15222"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15223which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015224frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15225is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015226
15227Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15228slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15229with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15230
15231 Example :
15232 frontend http-in
15233 mode http
15234 option httplog
15235 log global
15236 default_backend bck
15237
15238 backend static
15239 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15240
15241 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15242 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15243 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015244 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015245
15246 Field Format Extract from the example above
15247 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15248 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015249 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015250 4 frontend_name http-in
15251 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015252 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015253 7 status_code 200
15254 8 bytes_read* 2750
15255 9 captured_request_cookie -
15256 10 captured_response_cookie -
15257 11 termination_state ----
15258 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15259 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15260 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15261 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15262 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015263
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264Detailed fields description :
15265 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015266 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15267 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15268 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015269 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15270 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15271 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015272
15273 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015274 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15275 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15276 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015277
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015278 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15279 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015280
15281 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15282 and processed the connection.
15283
15284 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15285 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15286 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15287
15288 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15289 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15290 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15291 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15292 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15293 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15294
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015295 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15296 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15297 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15298 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15299 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15300 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15301 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015302
15303 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15304 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15305 See "Timers" below for more details.
15306
15307 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15308 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15309 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15310 below for more details.
15311
15312 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15313 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15314 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15315 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15316 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15317 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15318 for more details.
15319
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015320 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15321 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15322 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15323 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15324 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15325 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15326 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15327 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015328
15329 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15330 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15331 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15332
15333 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15334 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15335 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15336 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15337 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15338 overflowing.
15339
15340 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15341 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15342 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15343 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15344 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15345 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15346 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15347 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15348
15349 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15350 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15351 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15352 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15353 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15354 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15355 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15356 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15357
15358 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15359 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15360 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15361 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15362 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15363 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15364 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15365
15366 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015367 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015368 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15369 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15370 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015371 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015372 system.
15373
15374 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15375 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15376 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15377 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15378 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15379 caused by a denial of service attack.
15380
15381 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15382 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15383 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15384 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15385 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15386 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15387 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15388 denial of service attack.
15389
15390 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15391 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15392 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15393 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15394 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15395 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15396 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15397 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15398 processed than on other servers.
15399
15400 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15401 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15402 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15403 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15404 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15405 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15406 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15407 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15408 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15409 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15410 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15411 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15412 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15413
15414 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15415 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15416 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15417 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15418 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15419 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15420 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15421 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15422
15423 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15424 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15425 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15426 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15427 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15428 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15429 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15430 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15431 occurs.
15432
15433 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15434 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15435 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15436 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15437 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15438 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15439 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15440 cookies" below for more details.
15441
15442 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15443 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15444 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15445 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15446 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15447 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15448 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15449 and cookies" below for more details.
15450
15451 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15452 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15453 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15454 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15455 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15456 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15457 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15458 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15459
15460
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200154618.2.4. Custom log format
15462------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015463
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015464The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015465mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015466
15467HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15468Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15469separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15470prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15471
15472Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15473variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015474("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015475
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015476If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015477as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015478less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15479the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15480
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015481Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015482In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015483in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015484
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015485Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15486'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15487https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15488such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15489
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015490Flags are :
15491 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015492 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015493 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15494 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015495
15496 Example:
15497
15498 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15499 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15500
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015501 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15502
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015503At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15504
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015505 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15506 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015507
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015508the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015509
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015510 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15511 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15512 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015513
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015514and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15515
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015516 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15517 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015518
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015519Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15520
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015521 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015522 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015523 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15524 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15525 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015526 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15527 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15528 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015529 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015530 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15531 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015532 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015533 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15534 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015535 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015536 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015537 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015538 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015539 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015540 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015541 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015542 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15543 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15544 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15545 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15546 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015547 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015548 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15549 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015550 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015551 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15552 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015553 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15554 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15555 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015556 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015557 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15558 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015559 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015560 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15561 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15562 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015563 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015564 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015565 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15566 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15567 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15568 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015569 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015570 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015571 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015572 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015573 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015574 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015575 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15576 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15577 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015578 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015579 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15580 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015581 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015582 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15583 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15584 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015585 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015586 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015587 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015588
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015589 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015590
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015591
155928.2.5. Error log format
15593-----------------------
15594
15595When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15596protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15597By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15598"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15599will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15600logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15601
15602The format looks like this :
15603
15604 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15605 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15606 Connection error during SSL handshake
15607
15608 Field Format Extract from the example above
15609 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15610 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15611 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15612 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15613 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15614
15615These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15616failures.
15617
15618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156198.3. Advanced logging options
15620-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015621
15622Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15623just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15624options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15625for more information about their usage.
15626
15627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156288.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15629------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015630
15631It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15632haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15633commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15634monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15635ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15636
15637 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15638 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15639 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15640 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15641
15642 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15643 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15644 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015645 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015646 such as other load-balancers.
15647
15648 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15649 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15650 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15651
15652
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156538.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15654----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015655
15656The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15657what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15658or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15659"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15660just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15661log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15662after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15663is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15664with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15665with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15666
15667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156688.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15669------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015670
15671Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15672for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15673"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15674retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15675raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15676a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15677file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15678you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15679"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15680
15681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15683--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015684
15685Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15686multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15687them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15688"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15689logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15690error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15691and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15692too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15693useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15694alternative.
15695
15696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156978.4. Timing events
15698------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015699
15700Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15701reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15702the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15703frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015704mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15705addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15706
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015707Timings events in HTTP mode:
15708
15709 first request 2nd request
15710 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15711 t tr t tr ...
15712 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15713 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15714 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15715 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15716 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15717
15718Timings events in TCP mode:
15719
15720 TCP session
15721 |<----------------->|
15722 t t
15723 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15724 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15725 |<------ Tt ------->|
15726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015727 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15728 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15729 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15730 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15731 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15732 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15733 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015734
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015735 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15736 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15737 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15738 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15739 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15740 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15741 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15742 nothing was received on the connection.
15743
15744 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15745 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15746 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15747 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15748 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15749 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15750 request typed by hand during a test.
15751
15752 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15753 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15754 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15755 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15756 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15757 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15758 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015759
15760 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15761 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15762 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15763 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15764 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15765
15766 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15767 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15768 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15769 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15770 connection never established.
15771
15772 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15773 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15774 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15775 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15776 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15777 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15778 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15779 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15780 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15781 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15782 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15783
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015784 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15785 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15786 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15787 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15788 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15789 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15790
15791 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15792
15793 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15794 "Ta" can never be negative.
15795
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015796 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15797 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015798 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15799 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015800 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015801
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015802 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015803
15804 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015805 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15806 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015807
15808These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15809protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15810that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015811due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15812"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15813that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015814
15815Most common cases :
15816
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015817 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15818 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15819 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15820 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15821 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15822 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15823 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15824 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15825 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15826 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15827 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015828 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015829
15830 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15831 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15832 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15833 of ms on remote networks.
15834
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015835 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15836 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15837 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015838
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015839 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15840 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15841 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15842 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15843 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15844 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15845 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15846 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15847 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015848
15849Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15850
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015851 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015852 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015853 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015854
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015855 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015856 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15857 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15858
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015859 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015860 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15861 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15862 flags.
15863
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015864 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15865 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015866 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15867 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15868 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15869 the client connection was maintained open.
15870
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015871 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015872 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015873 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15875
15876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158778.5. Session state at disconnection
15878-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015879
15880TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15881"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
158822-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15883each of which has a special meaning :
15884
15885 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15886 session to terminate :
15887
15888 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15889
15890 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15891 server explicitly refused it.
15892
15893 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15894 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15895 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15896 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015897 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15898
15899 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15900 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015901
15902 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15903 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15904 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15905 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15906 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15907
15908 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15909 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15910 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15911 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15912 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15913
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015914 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15915 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15916
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015917 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15918 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15919 backup connections when going up.
15920
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015921 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15922
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015923 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15924 send or receive data.
15925
15926 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15927 send or receive data.
15928
15929 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15930 with nothing left in the buffers.
15931
15932 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15933
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015934 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015935 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15936
15937 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15938 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15939 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15940 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15941 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15942
15943 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15944 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15945
15946 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15947 server (HTTP only).
15948
15949 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15950
15951 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15952 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15953 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15954
15955 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15956 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15957 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15958
15959 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15960
15961 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15962 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15963
15964 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15965 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15966 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15967
15968 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15969 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015970 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15971 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015972
15973 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15974 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15975 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15976 another server.
15977
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015978 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979 server.
15980
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015981 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15982 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15983 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15984 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15985
15986 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15987 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15988 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15989 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15990
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015991 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15992 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15993 "use-server" rule).
15994
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015995 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15996
15997 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15998 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15999
16000 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16001
16002 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16003 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16004 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16005
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016006 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16007 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016008 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016009 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16010 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16011
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016012 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16013
16014 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16015 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16016
16017 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16018
16019 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16020
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016021The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16022was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016023helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16024starvation, attacks, etc...
16025
16026The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16027alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16028easier finding and understanding.
16029
16030 Flags Reason
16031
16032 -- Normal termination.
16033
16034 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16035 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16036 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16037 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16038
16039 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16040 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16041 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16042 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16043 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16044 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016046 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16047 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016048 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016049
16050 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16051 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16052 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16053
16054 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16055 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16056 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16057 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16058 the server takes too long to respond.
16059
16060 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16061 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16062 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16063 long a time to respond.
16064
16065 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16066 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16067 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16068 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016069 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16070 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016071
16072 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16073 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16074 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16075 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16076 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016077 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016078 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16079 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16080 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16081 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16082 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16083 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16084 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16085 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16086 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16087 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16088 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16089 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016090
16091 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16092 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016093 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16094 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16095 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16096 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016098 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16099 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016101 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016102 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16103 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16104 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16105 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16106 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16107
16108 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16109 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16110 503 or 504 here.
16111
16112 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16113 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16114 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16115 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16116 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16117
16118 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16119 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016120 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016121 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16122 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16123
16124 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16125 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16126 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16127 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16128 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16129 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16130 between haproxy and the server.
16131
16132 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16133 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16134 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16135 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16136 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16137 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16138 solution is to fix the application.
16139
16140 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16141 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16142 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16143 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16144 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16145 external attacks.
16146
16147 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16148 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016149 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016150 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16151 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16152
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016153 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16154 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16155 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016156 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16157 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016158
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016159 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16160 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16161 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16162 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016163 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16164 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16165 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16166 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16167 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168
16169 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16170 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16171 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16172 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16173
16174 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16175 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16176 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16177 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16178
16179 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16180 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16181 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16182 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16183
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016184The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16185persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16186important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16187re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16188
16189 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16190
16191 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16192 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16193 set on a GET request.
16194
16195 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16196 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016197 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016198 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16199
16200 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16201 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16202 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16203
16204 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16205 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16206 already got a cookie.
16207
16208 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16209 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16210 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16211 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16212 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16213
16214 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16215 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16216 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16217
16218 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16219 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16220 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16221
16222 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16223 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16224
16225 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16226 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16227 then advertised in the response.
16228
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162308.6. Non-printable characters
16231-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016232
16233In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16234consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16235converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16236prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16237being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16238escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16239is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16240'}' when logging headers.
16241
16242Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16243issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16244containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16245
16246Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16247the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16248performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16249
16250
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162518.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16252---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016253
16254Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16255achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016256section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016257cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16258the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16259the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016260locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016261not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16262user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16263a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16264wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16265
16266 Examples :
16267 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16268 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16269
16270 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16271 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16272
16273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162748.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16275---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016276
16277Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16278proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16279the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16280server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16281
16282Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16283response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016284section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016285
16286It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016287time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16288appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016289are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16290and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16291follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16292request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16293in the logs.
16294
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016295As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16296frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16297an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016299 Example :
16300 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16301 listen proxy-out
16302 mode http
16303 option httplog
16304 option logasap
16305 log global
16306 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16307
16308 # log the name of the virtual server
16309 capture request header Host len 20
16310
16311 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16312 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16313
16314 # log the beginning of the referrer
16315 capture request header Referer len 20
16316
16317 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16318 capture response header Server len 20
16319
16320 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16321 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16322
16323 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16324 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16325
16326 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16327 capture response header Via len 20
16328
16329 # log the URL location during a redirection
16330 capture response header Location len 20
16331
16332 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16333 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16334 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16335 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16336 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16337
16338 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16339 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16340 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16341 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016342 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016343
16344 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16345 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16346 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16347 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16348 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016349 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016350
16351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163528.9. Examples of logs
16353---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016354
16355These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16356them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16357reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16358
16359 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16360 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16361 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16362
16363 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16364 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16365
16366 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16367 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16368 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16369
16370 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16371 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16372
16373 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16374 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16375 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16376
16377 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016378 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016379 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16380 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16381
16382 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16383 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16384 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16385
16386 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16387 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016388 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016389 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16390 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16391 to return the 502 and not the server.
16392
16393 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016394 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016395
16396 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16397 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16398 Nothing was sent to any server.
16399
16400 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16401 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16402
16403 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16404 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16405 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16406 send a 408 return code to the client.
16407
16408 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16409 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16410
16411 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16412 5 seconds ("c----").
16413
16414 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16415 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016416 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016417
16418 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016419 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16421 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16422 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16423 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16424 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016425
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016426
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200164279. Supported filters
16428--------------------
16429
16430Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16431accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16432unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16433
16434See also : "filter"
16435
164369.1. Trace
16437----------
16438
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016439filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016440
16441 Arguments:
16442 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16443 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16444
16445 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16446 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16447 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16448 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16449
16450 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16451 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16452 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16453 amount of the parsed data.
16454
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016455 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16456
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016457This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16458callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16459information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16460filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16461
16462Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16463tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16464a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16465
16466
164679.2. HTTP compression
16468---------------------
16469
16470filter compression
16471
16472The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16473keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16474when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16475use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16476used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16477filters evaluation order.
16478
16479See also : "compression"
16480
16481
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200164829.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16483--------------------------------------------
16484
16485filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16486
16487 Arguments :
16488
16489 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16490 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16491 parsed.
16492
16493 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16494 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16495 part must be placed in its own scope.
16496
16497The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16498external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16499streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16500exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16501also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16502
16503SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16504the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16505
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016506For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016507"doc/SPOE.txt".
16508
16509Important note:
16510 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16511 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16512
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016513/*
16514 * Local variables:
16515 * fill-column: 79
16516 * End:
16517 */